blob: 837862c5e2818f9fde0910fb027bbd0e44ca0257 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau73b943b2020-05-22 16:19:04 +02007 2020/05/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200616 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100617 - presetenv
618 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200619 - uid
620 - ulimit-n
621 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200622 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200624 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-options
629 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-options
632 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100633 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200634 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100635 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100636 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100637 - 51degrees-data-file
638 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200639 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200640 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200641 - wurfl-data-file
642 - wurfl-information-list
643 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200644 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100645 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100648 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200649 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200651 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100652 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100653 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100654 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200655 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200656 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200657 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200658 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659 - noepoll
660 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000661 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100663 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300664 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000665 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100666 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200667 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200668 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200669 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000670 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000671 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200672 - tune.buffers.limit
673 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200674 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200675 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100676 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200677 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200678 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200679 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100680 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200681 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200682 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100694 - tune.rcvbuf.client
695 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100696 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200697 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200702 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100703 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200704 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200705 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100706 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100708 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200709 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
710 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
711 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100712 - tune.zlib.memlevel
713 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715 * Debugging
716 - debug
717 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200718 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722------------------------------------
723
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200724ca-base <dir>
725 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100726 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
727 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
728 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200730chroot <jail dir>
731 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
732 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
733 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
734 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
735 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100736 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100737
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
739 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
740 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
741 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
742 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
743 set. These sets have the format
744
745 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
746
747 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
750 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100751 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
752 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100753 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100757 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
758 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
759 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
760 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100761
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100762 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
763 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
764 on the machine's word size.
765
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
768 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
769 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
770 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
771 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
772 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100773
774 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100775 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
776
777 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
778 # first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
781 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
782 # word size.
783
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100785 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
789
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100790 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
791 # and so on.
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100796 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100797 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
798 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
799 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
800
801 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
802 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
803 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
804
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100805 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
806 # and a thread range.
807 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
810
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200811crt-base <dir>
812 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100813 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
814 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816daemon
817 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
818 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100819 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
820 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200822deviceatlas-json-file <path>
823 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100824 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825
826deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
829
830deviceatlas-separator <char>
831 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
832 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
833
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100834deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200835 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
836 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
837 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100838
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900839external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100840 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
841 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100842 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
843 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
844 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
845 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
846 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900847
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200848gid <number>
849 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
850 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
851 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100852 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
853 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100855
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100856group <group name>
857 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
858 See also "gid" and "user".
859
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100860hard-stop-after <time>
861 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
862
863 Arguments :
864 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
865 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
866 SIGUSR1 signal.
867
868 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
869 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
870 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 hard-stop-after 30s
875
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200876h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
877 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
878 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
879 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
880 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500881 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200882 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
883 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
884 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
885 specified in a proxy.
886
887 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
888 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
889 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
890 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
891 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
892 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
893 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
894
895 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
896 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
897 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
898 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
899 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
900
901 Example:
902 global
903 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
904
905 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
906 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
907
908h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
909 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
910 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
911 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
912 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
913 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
914 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
915 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
916 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
917
918 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
919 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
920 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
921
922 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
923 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
924
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100925insecure-fork-wanted
926 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
927 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
928 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
929 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
930 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
931 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
932 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
933 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
934 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
935 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
936 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
937 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
938 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
939 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
940 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
941 disable it.
942
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100943insecure-setuid-wanted
944 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
945 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
946 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
947 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
948 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
949 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
950 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
951 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
952 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
953 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
954 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
955 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
956 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
957 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
958
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100959issuers-chain-path <dir>
960 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
961 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
962 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
963 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
964 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
965 "issuers-chain-path".
966 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
967 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
968 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
969 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
970 will share the chain in memory.
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
973 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100974 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100975 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100976 configured with "log global".
977
978 <address> can be one of:
979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100980 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100981 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
982 port).
983
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100984 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
985 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
986 port).
987
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100988 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100989 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
990 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100992
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100993 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
994 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
995 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
996 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
997 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
998 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
999 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1000 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1001 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1002 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1003 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1004 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1005 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1006 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001007 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1008 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001009
1010 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1011 "fd@2", see above.
1012
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001013 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1014 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1015 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1016 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1017 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1018
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001019 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1020 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001021
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001022 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1023 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1024 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1025 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1026 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1027 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1028 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1029 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1030 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1031 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001032 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1033 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001035 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1036 one of the following :
1037
1038 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1039 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1040
1041 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1042 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1043
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001044 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1045 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1046 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1047 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1048 logger consumes.
1049
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001050 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1051 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1052 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1053 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1054
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001055 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1056 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1057 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1058 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1059 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1060
1061 <sample_size>
1062 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1063 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1064 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1065 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1066 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1067
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001068 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001070 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1071 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1072 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1073
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001074 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1075 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1076 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1077 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001078
1079 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001080 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1081 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1082 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1083 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1084 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1085 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001087 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001089log-send-hostname [<string>]
1090 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1091 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1092 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1093 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1094 the logs.
1095
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001096log-tag <string>
1097 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1098 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1099 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001100 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001101
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001102lua-load <file>
1103 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1104 used multiple times.
1105
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001106lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1107 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1108 variable.
1109 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1110 to "path".
1111
1112 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1113 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1114 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1115 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1116 will be checked earlier.
1117
1118 As an example by specifying the following path:
1119
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1121 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1122
1123 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1125 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1126 paths if that does not exist either.
1127
1128 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1129 documentation.
1130
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001131master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001132 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1133 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1134 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001135 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001136 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1137 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001138 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1139 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1140 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1141 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1142 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001144 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001145
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001146mworker-max-reloads <number>
1147 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001148 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001149 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1150 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1151 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1152
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001153nbproc <number>
1154 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1155 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1156 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001157 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1158 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001159 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1160 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001162nbthread <number>
1163 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001164 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1165 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1166 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1167 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1168 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001169 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1170 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1171 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1172 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1173 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1174 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1175 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001178 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1180 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1181
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001182pp2-never-send-local
1183 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1184 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1185 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1186 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1187 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1188 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1189 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1190 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1191 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1192 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1193 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1194
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001195presetenv <name> <value>
1196 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1197 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1198 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1199 and "unsetenv".
1200
1201resetenv [<name> ...]
1202 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1203 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1204 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1205 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1206 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1207 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1208 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1209 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001212 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1213 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1214 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1215 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1216 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1217 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001218 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001219 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1220 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1221 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1222 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001223
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001224server-state-base <directory>
1225 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001226 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1227 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001228
1229server-state-file <file>
1230 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1231 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1232 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1233 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1234 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1235 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1236 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1237 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001238 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1239 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001240
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001241setenv <name> <value>
1242 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1243 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1244 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1245 and "unsetenv".
1246
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001247set-dumpable
1248 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001249 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1250 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1251 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1252 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1253 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1254 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1255 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1256 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1257 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1258 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1259 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1260 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1261 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1262 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1263 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1264 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1265 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001266
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001267ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1269 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001270 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001271 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001272 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1273 information and recommendations see e.g.
1274 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1275 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1276 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1277 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1282 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1283 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1284 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001288 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001290ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1293 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1294 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1295 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1296
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001297ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1299 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1300 keyword to see available options.
1301
1302 Example:
1303 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001304 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001305
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001306ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1308 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001309 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001310 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1312 information and recommendations see e.g.
1313 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1314 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1315 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1316 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1317 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001318
1319ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1321 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1322 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1323 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1324 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001325 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1326 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1327 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1328 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001329
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001330ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1332 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1333 keyword to see available options.
1334
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001335ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1337 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1338 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001339 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001340 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001341 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1342 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1343 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1344 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001345 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1346 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1347 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1348
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001349ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001350 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1351 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1352
1353 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1354 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1355 optimize the startup time.
1356
1357 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1358 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1359 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1360
1361 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001362 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001363
1364 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1365 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1366 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1367 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1368 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1369 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001370 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001371 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1372
1373 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1374
1375 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1376
1377 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1378 not provided in the PEM file.
1379
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001380 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1381 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1382
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001383 The default behavior is "all".
1384
1385 Example:
1386 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1387 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1388 ssl-load-extra-files none
1389
1390 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1391
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001392ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1393 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1394 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1395 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1396
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001397ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1398 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1399 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1400 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1401 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1402 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1403 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1404 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1405 bits does not need it.
1406
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001407stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1408 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1409 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1410 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001411 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001412 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001413
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001414 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1415 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1416 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001417
1418stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1419 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1420 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001421 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001422
1423stats maxconn <connections>
1424 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1425 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427uid <number>
1428 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1429 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1430 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1431 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1432
1433ulimit-n <number>
1434 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1435 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1436 option.
1437
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001438unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1439 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1440
1441 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1442 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1443 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1444 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1445 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1446 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1447 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1448 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1449 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1450 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1451
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001452unsetenv [<name> ...]
1453 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1454 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1455 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1456 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1457 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1458 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1459 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1460
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461user <user name>
1462 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1463 See also "uid" and "group".
1464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001465node <name>
1466 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1467
1468 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1469 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1470 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1471 traffic.
1472
1473description <text>
1474 Add a text that describes the instance.
1475
1476 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1477 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1478 "<" and ">" characters.
1479
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100148051degrees-data-file <file path>
1481 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001482 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000148751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001488 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1489 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1490 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1491
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200149551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001496 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1497 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1498
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1500 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1501
150251degrees-cache-size <number>
1503 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1504 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1505 By default, this cache is disabled.
1506
1507 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001508 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1509
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001510wurfl-data-file <file path>
1511 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1512 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1513
1514 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1515 with USE_WURFL=1.
1516
1517wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1518 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1519 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1520 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1521
1522 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1523
1524 Valid WURFL properties are:
1525 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1526
1527 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1528 device.
1529
1530 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1531 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1532
1533 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1534 particular web request.
1535
1536 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1537 used Libwurfl API version.
1538
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001539 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1540 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1541
1542 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1543 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1544
1545 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1546
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
1550wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1551 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1552 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1553
1554 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1555 with USE_WURFL=1.
1556
1557wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1558 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1559 thus before the chroot.
1560
1561 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1562 with USE_WURFL=1.
1563
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001564wurfl-cache-size <size>
1565 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1566 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001567 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001568 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001569
1570 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1571 with USE_WURFL=1.
1572
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001573strict-limits
1574 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1575 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1576 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1577 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1578 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1579 keyword.
1580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015813.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001582-----------------------
1583
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001584busy-polling
1585 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1586 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1587 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1588 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1589 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1590 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1591 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1592 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1593 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1594 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1595 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1596 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1597 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1598 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1599 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1600 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1601 "poll" pollers.
1602
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001603 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1604 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1605 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1606
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001607max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1608 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1609 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1610 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1611 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1612 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1613 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1614 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1615 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1616
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617maxconn <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1619 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1620 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001621 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1622 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1623 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1624 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001625 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1626 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1627 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1628 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1629 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1630 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001632maxconnrate <number>
1633 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1634 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1635 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1636 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1637 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1638 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1639 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1640 fairness.
1641
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001642maxcomprate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001644 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001645 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1646 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1647 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001648 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001649 default value.
1650
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001651maxcompcpuusage <number>
1652 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1653 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1654 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1655 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1656 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1657 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1658 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1659 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1660
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001661maxpipes <number>
1662 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1663 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1664 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1665 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1666 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1667 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1668
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001669maxsessrate <number>
1670 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1671 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1672 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1673 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1674 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1675 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1676 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1677 fairness.
1678
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679maxsslconn <number>
1680 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1681 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1682 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1683 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1684 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1685 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1686 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001687 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1688 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1689 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1690 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1691 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1692 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1693 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001694
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001695maxsslrate <number>
1696 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1697 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1698 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1699 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1700 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1701 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1702 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1703 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1704 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1705 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1706
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001707maxzlibmem <number>
1708 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1709 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1710 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001711 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1712 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1713 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001715noepoll
1716 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1717 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001718 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001719
1720nokqueue
1721 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1722 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1723 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1724
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001725noevports
1726 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1727 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1728 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1729 also "nopoll".
1730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001731nopoll
1732 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1733 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001735 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1736 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001737
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001738nosplice
1739 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001741 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001743 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1744 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1745 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1746 "option splice-response".
1747
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001748nogetaddrinfo
1749 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1750 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1751
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001752noreuseport
1753 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1754 command line argument "-dR".
1755
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001756profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1757 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1758 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1759 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1760 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001761 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001762 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1763 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1764 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1765 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1766
1767 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1768 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1769 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1770 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1771 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001772 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1773 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1774 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1775 CLI.
1776
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001777spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001778 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1779 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1780 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1781 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1782 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1783 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001785ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001786 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001787 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001788 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1789 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1790 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1791 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1792 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1794 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001795 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1796 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1797 openssl configuration file uses:
1798 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1799
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001800ssl-mode-async
1801 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001802 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001803 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1804 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1805 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001806 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001807 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001808
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001809tune.buffers.limit <number>
1810 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1811 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1812 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1813 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1814 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001815 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001816 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1817 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1818 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1819 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1820 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1821 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1822 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1823 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1824 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1825
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001826tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1827 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1828 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1829 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1830 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1831
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832tune.bufsize <number>
1833 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1834 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1835 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1836 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1837 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1838 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1839 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001840 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1841 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1842 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001843 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001844 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1845 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1846 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001847
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001848tune.chksize <number>
1849 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1850 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1851 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1852 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1853 checks whenever possible.
1854
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001855tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1856 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1857 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1858 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1859 this value. The default value is 1.
1860
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001861tune.fail-alloc
1862 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1863 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1864 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1865 gracefully.
1866
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001867tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1868 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1869 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1870 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1871 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1872 change it.
1873
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001874tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1875 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1877 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001878 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1879 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1880 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1881 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1882 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1883
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001884tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1885 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1886 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1887 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1888 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1889 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1890 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1891 recommended not to change this value.
1892
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001893tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1894 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1895 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1896 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1897 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1898 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1899 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1900 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1901
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001902tune.http.cookielen <number>
1903 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1904 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1905 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1906 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1907 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1908 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1909 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1910 to change this value.
1911
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001912tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001913 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1914 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001915 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001916 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001917 configuration directives too.
1918 The default value is 1024.
1919
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001920tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1921 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1922 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1923 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1924 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1925 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1926 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001927 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1928 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1929 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001930
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001931tune.idletimer <timeout>
1932 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1933 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1934 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1935 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1936 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1937 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001940 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1941
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001942tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1943 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1944 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1945 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1946 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1947 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1948 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1949 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1950 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1951 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1954 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001955 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001956 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1957 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1960 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1961
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001962tune.lua.maxmem
1963 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1964 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1965 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1966 memory.
1967
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001968tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1969 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1971 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001972 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001973
1974tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1975 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1976 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1977 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1978 check servers.
1979
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001980tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1981 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1982 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1983 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001984 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001985
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001986tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001987 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1988 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1989 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1990 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1991 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1992 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1993 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1994 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1995 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1996 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001997
1998tune.maxpollevents <number>
1999 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2000 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2001 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2002 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2003 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2004
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002005tune.maxrewrite <number>
2006 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2007 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2008 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2009 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2010 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2011 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2012 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2013 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2014 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2015 bufsize.
2016
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002017tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2018 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2019 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2020 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2021 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2022 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2023 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2024 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2025 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2026 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002027 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2028 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002029 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2030 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2031 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2032 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2033 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2034 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2035 setting this parameter to 0.
2036
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002037tune.pipesize <number>
2038 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2039 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2040 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2041 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2042 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2043 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2044
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2046 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2047 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2048 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2049 default is 20.
2050
2051tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2052 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2053 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2054 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2055 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2056 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2057 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002058 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002059
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002060tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2061tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2062 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2063 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2064 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002065 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002066 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2068 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2069
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002070tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002071 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002072 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2073 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2074 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2075 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2076
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002077tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002078 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002079 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2080 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2081
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002082tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2083tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2084 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2085 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2086 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002087 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002089 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2090 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2091 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2092 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2093 notifying haproxy again.
2094
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002095tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002096 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2097 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2098 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002099 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002100 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002101 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002102 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2103 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2104 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002105 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2106 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002107
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002108tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002109 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002110 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2111 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2112 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2113 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2114 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2115
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002116tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2117 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002118 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002119 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2120 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2121 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2122 being used for too long.
2123
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002124tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2125 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2126 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2127 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2128 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2129 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2130 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2131 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2132 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2133 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2134 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002135 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002136 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002137
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002138tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2139 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2140 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2141 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2142 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002143 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002144 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2145 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002146 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2147 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002148
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002149tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2150 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2151 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2152 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2153 1000 entries.
2154
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002155tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2156 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2157 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2158 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2159
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002160tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002161tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002162tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2163tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2164tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002165 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2166 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2167 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2168 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2169 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2170 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2171 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2172 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002173
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002174 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2175 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2176 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2177 all available space is consumed.
2178 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2179 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2180 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002181
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002182tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2183 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002184 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002185 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002186 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002187 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2188
2189tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2190 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2191 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002192 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2193 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021953.3. Debugging
2196--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002198debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002199 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2200 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2201 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2202 system startup.
2203
2204quiet
2205 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2206 line argument "-q".
2207
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002208zero-warning
2209 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2210 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2211 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2212 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2213 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2214 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2215
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022173.4. Userlists
2218--------------
2219It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2220http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2221it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2222
2223userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002224 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2226
2227group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002228 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002229 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2230 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2231
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002232user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2233 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002234 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2235 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002236 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2237 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2238 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2239 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002241 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2242 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2243 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2244 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2245 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2246 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2247 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2248 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2249 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002250
2251 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002252 userlist L1
2253 group G1 users tiger,scott
2254 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002255
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002256 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2257 user scott insecure-password elgato
2258 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002259
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002260 userlist L2
2261 group G1
2262 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002263
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002264 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2265 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2266 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002267
2268 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002269
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
22713.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002272----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002273It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2274several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2275instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2276values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2277automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2278In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2279using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2280tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2281reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2282Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2283that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2284each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002285
2286peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002287 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002288 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2289
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002290bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2291 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2292 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2293
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002294disabled
2295 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2296 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2297 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2298
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002299default-bind [param*]
2300 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2301
2302default-server [param*]
2303 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2304
2305 Arguments:
2306 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2307 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2308 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2309 details.
2310
2311
2312 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2313
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002314enable
2315 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2316
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002317log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2318 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2319 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2320 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2321 more details.
2322
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002323peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002324 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2325 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2326 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2327 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2328 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2329 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2330
2331 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2332 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2333
2334 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2335 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2336 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2337 across all peers.
2338
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002339 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2340 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002341
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002342 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2343 "server" keyword explanation below).
2344
2345server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002346 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002347 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2348 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2349 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2350 of this "peers" section).
2351 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2352
2353
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002354 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002356 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002357 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2358 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2359 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002360
2361 backend mybackend
2362 mode tcp
2363 balance roundrobin
2364 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2365 stick on src
2366
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002367 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2368 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002369
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002370 Example:
2371 peers mypeers
2372 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2373 default-server ssl verify none
2374 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2375 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002376
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002377
2378table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2379 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2380
2381 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2382 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002383 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002384 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2385 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2386 "stick-table" keyword).
2387
2388 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2389 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2390 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2391 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2392 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2393 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2394 of the stick-table name as follows:
2395
2396 peers mypeers
2397 peer A ...
2398 peer B ...
2399 table t1 ...
2400
2401 frontend fe1
2402 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2403
2404 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2405 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2406
2407 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2408 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2409 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2410 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2411 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2412 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2413 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2414
2415 peers mypeers
2416 peer A ...
2417 peer B ...
2418 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2419
2420 backend t1
2421 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2422
2423 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2424 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2425 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2426
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024273.6. Mailers
2428------------
2429It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2430If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2431in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2432
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002433mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002434 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2435 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2436
2437mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2438 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2439
2440 Example:
2441 mailers mymailers
2442 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2443 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2444
2445 backend mybackend
2446 mode tcp
2447 balance roundrobin
2448
2449 email-alert mailers mymailers
2450 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2451 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2452
2453 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2454 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2455
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002456timeout mail <time>
2457 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2458 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2459 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2460 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2461
2462 Example:
2463 mailers mymailers
2464 timeout mail 20s
2465 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002466
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024673.7. Programs
2468-------------
2469In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2470master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2471managed the same way as the workers.
2472
2473During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2474sequence as a worker:
2475
2476 - the master is re-executed
2477 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2478 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2479 instance of the program
2480
2481During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2482
2483program <name>
2484 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2485 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2486 the management guide).
2487
2488command <command> [arguments*]
2489 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2490 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2491 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2492 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2493
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002494user <user name>
2495 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2496 See also "group".
2497
2498group <group name>
2499 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2500 See also "user".
2501
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002502option start-on-reload
2503no option start-on-reload
2504 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2505 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2506 program section.
2507
2508
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025093.8. HTTP-errors
2510----------------
2511
2512It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2513imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2514several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2515
2516http-errors <name>
2517 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2518 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2519
2520errorfile <code> <file>
2521 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2522
2523 Arguments :
2524 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002525 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2526 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002527
2528 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2529 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2530 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2531 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2532 before any chroot is performed.
2533
2534 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2535
2536 Example:
2537 http-errors website-1
2538 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2539 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2540 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2541
2542 http-errors website-2
2543 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2544 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2545 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2546
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025473.9. Rings
2548----------
2549
2550It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2551servers or traces.
2552
2553ring <ringname>
2554 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2555
2556description <text>
2557 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2558 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2559
2560format <format>
2561 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2562
2563 Arguments:
2564 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2565 one of the following :
2566
2567 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2568 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2569 designed to be used with a local log server.
2570
2571 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2572 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2573 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2574 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2575 is the default.
2576
2577 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2579
2580 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2581 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2582
2583 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2584 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2585 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2586 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2587 logger consumes.
2588
2589 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2590 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2591 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2592 used with a local log server.
2593
2594maxlen <length>
2595 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2596 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2597 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2598
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002599server <name> <address> [param*]
2600 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2601 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2602 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2603 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2604 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2605 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2606 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2607 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2608 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002609 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2610 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002611
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002612size <size>
2613 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2614 set to BUFSIZE.
2615
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002616timeout connect <timeout>
2617 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2618
2619 Arguments :
2620 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2621 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2622 as explained at the top of this document.
2623
2624timeout server <timeout>
2625 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2626
2627 Arguments :
2628 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2630 as explained at the top of this document.
2631
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002632 Example:
2633 global
2634 log ring@myring local7
2635
2636 ring myring
2637 description "My local buffer"
2638 format rfc3164
2639 maxlen 1200
2640 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002641 timeout connect 5s
2642 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002643 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002644
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002647----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002649Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002650 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002651 - frontend <name>
2652 - backend <name>
2653 - listen <name>
2654
2655A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2656its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2657section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002659
2660A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2661connections.
2662
2663A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2664to forward incoming connections.
2665
2666A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2667parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2670'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2671case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2672
2673Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2674logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2675proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2676However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2677name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2678
2679Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2680and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002681bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2683modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2684arbitrary criteria.
2685
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002686In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2687a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002688the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002689
2690 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2691 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2692 between responses and new requests.
2693
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002694 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2695 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2696 client-facing connection remains open.
2697
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002698 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2699 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002700
2701The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2702frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2703following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002704weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002705
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002706 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002707
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002708 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2709 ----+-----+-----+----
2710 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2711 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002712 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2713 ----+-----+-----+----
2714 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027184.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2719--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002721The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2722limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2723they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2724limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002725marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002726option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002727and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2728with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2729specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002731
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002732 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2733------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2734acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735backlog X X X -
2736balance X - X X
2737bind - X X -
2738bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739capture cookie - X X -
2740capture request header - X X -
2741capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002742compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002743cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002744declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002745default-server X - X X
2746default_backend X X X -
2747description - X X X
2748disabled X X X X
2749dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002750email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002751email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002752email-alert mailers X X X X
2753email-alert myhostname X X X X
2754email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002755enabled X X X X
2756errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002757errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002758errorloc X X X X
2759errorloc302 X X X X
2760-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2761errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002762force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002763filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002764fullconn X - X X
2765grace X X X X
2766hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002767http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002768http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002769http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002770http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002771http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002772http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002773http-check set-var X - X X
2774http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002775http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002777http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002778http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002779http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002781ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002782load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002783log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002784log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002785log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002786log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002787max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788maxconn X X X -
2789mode X X X X
2790monitor fail - X X -
2791monitor-net X X X -
2792monitor-uri X X X -
2793option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2794option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2795option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2796option allbackups (*) X - X X
2797option checkcache (*) X - X X
2798option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2799option contstats (*) X X X -
2800option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2801option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002802-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2803option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002804option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2805option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002806option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002807option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002808option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002809option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002810option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002811option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2812option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2813option httpchk X - X X
2814option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002815option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002816option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002817option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002818option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002819option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002820option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2821option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2822option logasap (*) X X X -
2823option mysql-check X - X X
2824option nolinger (*) X X X X
2825option originalto X X X X
2826option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002827option pgsql-check X - X X
2828option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002829option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002830option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002831option smtpchk X - X X
2832option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2833option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2834option splice-request (*) X X X X
2835option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002836option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002837option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2838option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2839-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002840option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002841option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2842option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2843option tcpka X X X X
2844option tcplog X X X X
2845option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002846external-check command X - X X
2847external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002848persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2849rate-limit sessions X X X -
2850redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002851-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002852retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002853retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002854server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002855server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002856server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002857source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002858stats admin - X X X
2859stats auth X X X X
2860stats enable X X X X
2861stats hide-version X X X X
2862stats http-request - X X X
2863stats realm X X X X
2864stats refresh X X X X
2865stats scope X X X X
2866stats show-desc X X X X
2867stats show-legends X X X X
2868stats show-node X X X X
2869stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002870-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2871stick match - - X X
2872stick on - - X X
2873stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002874stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002875stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002876tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002877tcp-check connect X - X X
2878tcp-check expect X - X X
2879tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002880tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002881tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002882tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002883tcp-check set-var X - X X
2884tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002885tcp-request connection - X X -
2886tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002887tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002888tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002889tcp-response content - - X X
2890tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002891timeout check X - X X
2892timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002893timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002894timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002895timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2896timeout http-request X X X X
2897timeout queue X - X X
2898timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002899timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002900timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002901timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002902transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002903unique-id-format X X X -
2904unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002905use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002906use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002907use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002908------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2909 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002910
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029124.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2913---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002914
2915This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2916
2917
2918acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2919 Declare or complete an access list.
2920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2921 no | yes | yes | yes
2922 Example:
2923 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2924 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2925 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002927 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928
2929
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002930backlog <conns>
2931 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2933 yes | yes | yes | no
2934 Arguments :
2935 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2936 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002937 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002938
2939 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2940 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2941 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2942 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2943 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2944 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2945 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2946 backlog parameter.
2947
2948 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2949 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2950 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2951
2952 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2953
2954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002956balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2959 yes | no | yes | yes
2960 Arguments :
2961 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2962 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2963 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2964 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2965
2966 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2967 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2968 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2969 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002970 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002971 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002972 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2973 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2974 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2975 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2976 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2977 it, so that you don't worry.
2978
2979 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2980 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2981 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2982 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2983 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2984 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2985 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2986 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002987
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002988 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2989 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2990 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2991 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2992 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2993 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2994 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2995 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2996
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002997 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002998 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002999 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3000 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003001 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003002 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3003 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3004 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3005 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3006 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003007 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3008 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3009 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3010 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3011 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3012 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3015 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3016 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3017 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3018 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3019 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3020 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3021 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003022 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003024 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3025 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3026 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003027
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003028 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3029 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3030 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3031 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3032 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3033 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3034 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3035 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3036 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3037 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3038 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3039 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003041 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003042 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3043 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3044 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3045 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3046 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3047 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3048 URIs start with a leading "/".
3049
3050 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3051 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3052 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3053 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3054
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003056 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3057
3058 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003059 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3060 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003061 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3062 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3063 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3064 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003065 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003066 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3067 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003068
3069 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3070 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3071 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3072 server will receive the request.
3073
3074 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3075 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3076 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3077 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3078 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003079 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3080 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3081 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003083 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3084 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3085 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3086 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3087 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003089 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003090 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3091 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3092 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3093
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003094 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3095 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3096 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3097
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003098 random
3099 random(<draws>)
3100 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003101 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3102 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3103 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3104 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003105 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3106 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3107 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3108 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3109 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3110 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3111 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3112 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3113 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3114 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3115 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3116 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3117 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3118 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3119 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3120 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3121 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3122 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3123 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3124 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003125
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003126 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003127 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003128 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3129 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3130 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3131 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3132 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3133 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003134 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003135 used instead.
3136
3137 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3138 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3139 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3140 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3141
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003142 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3143 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3144 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3145
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003146 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003149 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3150 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003151
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003152 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3153 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3154 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003155
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003156 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003157 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003158 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3159 NTLM relies on.
3160
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161 Examples :
3162 balance roundrobin
3163 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003164 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003165 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3166 balance hdr(host)
3167 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003168
3169 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3170 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003172 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003173 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3174 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3175 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003176 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003177
3178 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3179 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3180 defaults to 16 kB.
3181
3182 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3183 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3184
3185 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3186 Round Robin.
3187
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003188 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003189 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3190 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3191 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3192
3193 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3194
3195 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003196 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003197 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3198 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3199 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003201 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202
3203
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003204bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3205bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 no | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003210 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3211 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3212 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3213 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003214 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003215 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3216 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3217 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3218 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3219 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3220 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3221 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003222 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3223 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3224 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3225 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3226 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3227 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3228 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003229 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3230 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3231 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003232 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3233 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3234 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3235 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003236 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3237 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3238 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003239
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003240 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3241 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003242 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3243 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3244 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003245 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3246 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3247 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3248 the range.
3249
3250 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3251 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3252 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3253 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3254 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3255 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3256 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003257 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003258 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003260 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003261 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003262 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3263 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3264 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3265 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3266 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3267 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3268
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003269 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3270 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3271 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3272 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3275 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3276 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3277 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3278 in a frontend.
3279
3280 Example :
3281 listen http_proxy
3282 bind :80,:443
3283 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003284 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003286 listen http_https_proxy
3287 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003288 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003289
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003290 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3291 bind ipv6@:80
3292 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3293 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3294
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003295 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003296 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003297
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003298 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3299 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3300 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3301 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3302 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3303
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003304 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003305 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
3307
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003308bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003309 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | yes | yes | yes
3312 Arguments :
3313 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3314 may be used to override a default value.
3315
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003316 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003317 option may be combined with other numbers.
3318
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003319 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003320 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3321 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3322 missing from all processes.
3323
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003324 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003325 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003326 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3327 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3328 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3329 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3330 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003331 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003332
3333 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3334 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3335 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3336 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3337 and 'even' instances.
3338
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003339 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3340 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3341 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3342 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003343
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003344 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3345 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3346
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003347 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3348 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3349 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3350
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003351 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3352 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3353
3354 Example :
3355 listen app_ip1
3356 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003357 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003358
3359 listen app_ip2
3360 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003361 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003362
3363 listen management
3364 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003365 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003366
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003367 listen management
3368 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3369 bind-process 1-4
3370
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003371 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003372
3373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003374capture cookie <name> len <length>
3375 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 no | yes | yes | no
3378 Arguments :
3379 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3380 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3381 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3382 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003383 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
3385 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3386 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3387 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3388 right if it exceeds <length>.
3389
3390 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3391 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3392 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3393 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3394
3395 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3396 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3397 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3398
3399 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3400 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3401 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003402 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3403 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3404 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
3406 Example:
3407 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3408
3409 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003410 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411
3412
3413capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003414 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3416 no | yes | yes | no
3417 Arguments :
3418 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003419 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3421 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3422 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3423
3424 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3425 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3426 it exceeds <length>.
3427
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003428 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3430 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003431 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3432 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3433 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3434 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003435 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003436 environments to find where the request came from.
3437
3438 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3439 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3440 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3441 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003443 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3444 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3445 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3446 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3447 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003448
3449 Example:
3450 capture request header Host len 15
3451 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003452 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003454 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 about logging.
3456
3457
3458capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003459 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 no | yes | yes | no
3462 Arguments :
3463 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003464 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3466 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3467 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3468
3469 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3470 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3471 it exceeds <length>.
3472
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003473 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3475 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3476 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003477 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3478 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3479 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3480 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003481
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003482 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3483 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3484 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3485 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3486 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003487
3488 Example:
3489 capture response header Content-length len 9
3490 capture response header Location len 15
3491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003492 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003493 about logging.
3494
3495
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003496compression algo <algorithm> ...
3497compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003498compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003499 Enable HTTP compression.
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | yes
3502 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003503 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3504 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3505 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3506
3507 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003508 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3509 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3510 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003511
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003512 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003513 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003514
3515 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3516 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3517 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3518 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3519 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003520 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003521
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003522 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3523 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3524 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3525 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3526 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3527 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3528 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003529 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003530
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003531 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003532 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003533 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3534 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3535 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3536 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3537 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003538
3539 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3540 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3541 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3542 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3543 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003544 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3545 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3546 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3547 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3548 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003549 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3550 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003551
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003552 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003553 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3554 "Accept-Encoding" header
3555 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003556 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003557 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3558 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3559 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3560 "multipart"
3561 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3562 header
3563 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3564 and later
3565 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3566 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003567 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003568
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003569 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003570
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003571 Examples :
3572 compression algo gzip
3573 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003575
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003576cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003577 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3578 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003579 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003580 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3582 yes | no | yes | yes
3583 Arguments :
3584 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3585 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3586 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3587 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3588 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3589 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003590 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3592 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3593
3594 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3595 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3596 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3597 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3598 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3599 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003600 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3601 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003602 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003603 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3604 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605
3606 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003607 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003608
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003609 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003610 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003611 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003613 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3614 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3615 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3616 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3617 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3618 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3619 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620
3621 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3622 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3623 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3624 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3625 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3626 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3627 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3628 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3629 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003630 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003631 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3632 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3633 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003635 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3636 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3637 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003638 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3639 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3640 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3641 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003642 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3643 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3644 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003645
3646 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3647 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3648 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3649 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3650 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3651 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3652 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3653 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3654 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3655
3656 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3657 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3658 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3659 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3660 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3661 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3662 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3663 persistence cookie in the cache.
3664 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3665
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003666 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3667 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3668 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3669 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3670 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003671 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003672 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3673 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3674 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3675 they logout.
3676
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003677 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3678 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3679 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3680 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3681
3682 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3683 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3684 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3685 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3686 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3687 this attribute.
3688
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003689 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003690 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003691 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3692 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3693 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3694 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3695 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3696 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003697
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003698 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3699 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3700 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3701 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3702 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3703 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3704 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3705 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003706 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003707 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3708 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3709 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3710 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3711 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3712 the site.
3713
3714 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3715 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3716 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3717 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3718 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3719 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3720 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3721 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3722 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3723 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3724 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3725 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3726 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003727 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003728 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3729 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3730
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003731 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3732 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3733 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3734 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3735 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3736 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3737
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003738 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3739 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3740 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3741 repeated.
3742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003743 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3744 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3745 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3746 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003748 Examples :
3749 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3750 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3751 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003752 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003754 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003756
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003757declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3758 Declares a capture slot.
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3760 no | yes | yes | no
3761 Arguments:
3762 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3763
3764 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3765 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3766 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3767 for use in the response.
3768
3769 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003770 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003771 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3772
3773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003774default-server [param*]
3775 Change default options for a server in a backend
3776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3777 yes | no | yes | yes
3778 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003779 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3780 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3781 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3782 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003783
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003784 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003785 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3786
3787 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790default_backend <backend>
3791 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 yes | yes | yes | no
3794 Arguments :
3795 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3796
3797 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3798 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3799 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3800 will catch all undetermined requests.
3801
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802 Example :
3803
3804 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3805 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3806 default_backend dynamic
3807
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003808 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003811description <string>
3812 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3814 no | yes | yes | yes
3815 Arguments : string
3816
3817 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3818 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3819 it describes.
3820 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3821
3822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003823disabled
3824 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827 Arguments : none
3828
3829 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3830 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3831 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3832 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3833 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3834 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3835 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3836
3837 See also : "enabled"
3838
3839
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003840dispatch <address>:<port>
3841 Set a default server address
3842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003844 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003845
3846 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3847 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3848 during start-up.
3849
3850 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3851 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3852 possible with normal servers.
3853
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003854 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003855 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3856 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3857 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3858 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3859
3860 See also : "server"
3861
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003862
3863dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3864 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3866 yes | no | yes | yes
3867 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3868
3869 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003870 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003871 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3872 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003873 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003874 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876enabled
3877 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | yes | yes | yes
3880 Arguments : none
3881
3882 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3883 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3884
3885 See also : "disabled"
3886
3887
3888errorfile <code> <file>
3889 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | yes | yes | yes
3892 Arguments :
3893 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003894 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3895 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896
3897 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003898 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003899 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003900 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3901 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003902
3903 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3904 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3905 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3906
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003907 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3908
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003909 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3910 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3911 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3912 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3913 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3914 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3915 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3916 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3917 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3920 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3921 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003922 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3924
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003925 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003926
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003927 Example :
3928 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003929 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003930 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3931 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003933
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003934errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3935 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3936 section.
3937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3938 yes | yes | yes | yes
3939 Arguments :
3940 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3941
3942 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003943 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
3944 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003945
3946 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3947 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3948 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3949 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3950 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3951 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3952 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3953
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003954 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
3955 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003956
3957 Example :
3958 errorfiles generic
3959 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3960
3961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962errorloc <code> <url>
3963errorloc302 <code> <url>
3964 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | yes | yes | yes
3967 Arguments :
3968 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003969 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3970 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003971
3972 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3973 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3974 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3975 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003976 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977
3978 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3979 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3980 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3981
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003982 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3983
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003984 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3985 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3986 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3987 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003988 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003989 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3990 request.
3991
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003992 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003993
3994
3995errorloc303 <code> <url>
3996 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3998 yes | yes | yes | yes
3999 Arguments :
4000 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004001 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
4002 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004003
4004 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4005 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4006 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4007 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004008 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004009
4010 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4011 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4012 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4013
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004014 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4015
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004016 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4017 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4018 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4019 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004020 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004021
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004022 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004023
4024
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004025email-alert from <emailaddr>
4026 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004027 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4029 yes | yes | yes | yes
4030
4031 Arguments :
4032
4033 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4034
4035 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4036 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4037
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004038 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004039 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4040 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004041
4042
4043email-alert level <level>
4044 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4045 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4046 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | yes | yes | yes
4048
4049 Arguments :
4050
4051 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4052 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4053 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4054
4055 By default level is alert
4056
4057 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4058 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4059 for the proxy.
4060
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004061 Alerts are sent when :
4062
4063 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4064 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4065 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4066 is notice or lower
4067 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4068 and a health check status update occurs
4069
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004070 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4071 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004072 section 3.6 about mailers.
4073
4074
4075email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4076 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | yes | yes | yes
4079
4080 Arguments :
4081
4082 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4083
4084 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4085 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4086
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004087 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4088 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004089
4090
4091email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4092 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4093 mailers.
4094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | yes | yes | yes
4096
4097 Arguments :
4098
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004099 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004100
4101 By default the systems hostname is used.
4102
4103 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4104 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4105 for the proxy.
4106
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004107 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4108 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004109
4110
4111email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004112 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004113 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | yes | yes | yes
4116
4117 Arguments :
4118
4119 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4120
4121 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4122 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4123
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004124 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004125 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4126
4127
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004128force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4129 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4130 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004131 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004132
4133 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4134 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4135 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4136 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4137 marked down for maintenance operations.
4138
4139 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4140 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4141 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4142 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4143 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4144 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4145 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4146 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4147 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4148
4149 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4150 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4151 is used.
4152
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004153 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004154 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004155
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004156
4157filter <name> [param*]
4158 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 no | yes | yes | yes
4161 Arguments :
4162 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4163 referenced in section 9.
4164
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004165 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004166 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004167 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4168 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004169
4170 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4171 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4172
4173 Example:
4174 listen
4175 bind *:80
4176
4177 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4178 filter compression
4179 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4180
4181 compression algo gzip
4182 compression offload
4183
4184 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4185
4186 See also : section 9.
4187
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004188
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004189fullconn <conns>
4190 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | no | yes | yes
4193 Arguments :
4194 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4195 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4196
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004197 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004198 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004199 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004200 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4201 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4202 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4203 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4204 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004205 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004206
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004207 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4208 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004209 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4210 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4211 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004212
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004213 Example :
4214 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4215 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4216 # connections.
4217 backend dynamic
4218 fullconn 10000
4219 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4220 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4221
4222 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4223
4224
4225grace <time>
4226 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004228 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004229 Arguments :
4230 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4231 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4232 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4233
4234 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4235 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004236 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004237 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4238
4239 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4240 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4241 simplify it.
4242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004243
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004244hash-balance-factor <factor>
4245 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 yes | no | no | yes
4248 Arguments :
4249 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4250 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004251 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004252
4253 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4254 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4255 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4256 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4257 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4258 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4259 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4260
4261 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4262 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4263 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4264 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4265 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4266
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004267 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4268 consistent hashing mechanism.
4269
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004270 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4271
4272
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004273hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004274 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4276 yes | no | yes | yes
4277 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004278 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4279 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004280
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004281 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4282 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4283 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4284 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4285 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4286 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4287 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4288 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4289 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4290 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004291
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004292 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4293 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4294 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4295 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4296 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4297 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4298 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4299 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4300 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4301 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4302 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4303 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4304 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004305 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4306 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004307
4308 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4309
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004310 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004311 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4312 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4313 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004314 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4315 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4316 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004317
4318 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4319 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004320 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4321 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4322 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4323 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4324
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004325 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4326 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4327 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4328 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4329 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4330 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4331 parameter.
4332
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004333 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4334 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4335 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4336 used on strings.
4337
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004338 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4339
4340 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4341 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4342 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4343 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4344 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4345 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4346 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4347 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4348 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4349 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4350 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4351 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004352
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004353 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4354 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4355 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004356
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004357 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004358
4359
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004360http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4361 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4362 ones).
4363
4364 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 no | yes | yes | yes
4366
4367 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4368 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4369 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4370 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4371 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4372 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4373
4374 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4375 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4376 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4377
4378 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4379 below.
4380
4381 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4382 instance.
4383
4384 Example:
4385 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4386 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4387 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4388
4389http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4390
4391 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4392 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4393 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4394 example, or to pass some internal information.
4395 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4396 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4397 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4398
4399http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4400
4401 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4402 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4403
4404http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4405
4406 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4407
4408http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4409 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4410
4411 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4412
4413 Example:
4414 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4415
4416 # applied to:
4417 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4418
4419 # outputs:
4420 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4421
4422 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4423
4424http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4425 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4426
4427 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4428
4429 Example:
4430 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4431
4432 # applied to:
4433 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4434
4435 # outputs:
4436 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4437
4438http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4439
4440 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4441 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4442 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4443
4444http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4446
4447 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4448 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4449 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4450 fallback.
4451
4452 Example:
4453 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4454 http-response set-status 431
4455 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4456 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4457
4458http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4459
4460 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4461 inline.
4462
4463 Arguments:
4464 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4465 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4466 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4467 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4468 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4469 (request and response)
4470 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4471 processing
4472 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4473 processing
4474 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4475 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4476 and '_'.
4477
4478 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4479 followed by some converters.
4480
4481 Example:
4482 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4483
4484http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4485
4486 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4487 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4488 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4489 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4490 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004491 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004492 processing.
4493
4494 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4495 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4496 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4497 rules evaluation.
4498
4499http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4500
4501 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4502 details about <var-name>.
4503
4504 Example:
4505 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4506
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004507
4508http-check comment <string>
4509 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4510 it fails.
4511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4512 yes | no | yes | yes
4513
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004514 Arguments :
4515 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4516 rule fails.
4517
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004518 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4519 user-friendly error reporting.
4520
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004521 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4522 "http-check expect".
4523
4524
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004525http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4526 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004527 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004528 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 yes | no | yes | yes
4531
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004532 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004533 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4534
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004535 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4536 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4537
4538 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4539 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4540 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4541 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4542
4543 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4544
4545 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4546
4547 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4548
4549 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4550
4551 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4552
4553 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4554 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4555 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4556 is used.
4557
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004558 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4559 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4560 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4561 haproxy -vv.
4562
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004563 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4564
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004565 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4566 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4567 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4568 different ports or with different servers.
4569
4570 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4571 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4572 the port with a "http-check connect".
4573
4574 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4575 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4576 do.
4577
4578 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4579 unset-var or comment rules.
4580
4581 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004582 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4583 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4584 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4585 option httpchk
4586
4587 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004588 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004589 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004590 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004591 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004592 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004593
4594 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4595
4596 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004599http-check disable-on-404
4600 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004603 Arguments : none
4604
4605 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4606 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4607 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4608 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4609 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4610 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4611 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4612 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004613 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4614 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4615 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4616
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004617 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004618
4619
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004620http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004621 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4622 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4623 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004624 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004626 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004627
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004628 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004629 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4630
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004631 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4632 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4633 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4634 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4635 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4636 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4637 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4638 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4639 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4640 result is always conclusive.
4641
4642 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4643 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4644 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004645 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4646 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4647 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4648 example 404 with disable-on-404
4649 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4650 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4651 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004652
4653 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4654 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004655 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4656 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4657 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4658 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4659 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4660 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004661
4662 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4663 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004664 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4665 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4666 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4667 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004668 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4669
4670 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4671 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4672 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4673 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4674
4675 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4676 informational message reported in logs if an error
4677 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4678 log-format string.
4679
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004680 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004681 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4682 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004683 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4684 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4685 details on the supported keywords.
4686
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004687 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4688 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4689 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4690 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004691
4692 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4693 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4694 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4695 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4696 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4697
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004698 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4699 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4700 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4701 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4702 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4703 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4704 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004705
4706 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004707 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004708 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4709 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4710 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4711 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4712
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004713 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4714 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004715 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4716 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4717 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4718 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4719 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4720 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4721 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4722 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004723 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4724 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4725 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4726 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4727 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4728 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4729 insensitive on the header names.
4730
4731 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4732 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4733 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4734 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4735 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4736 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004737
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004738 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004739 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004740 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4741 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4742 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4743 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4744 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004745 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004746 trace).
4747
4748 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004749 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004750 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4751 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4752 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4753 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4754 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004755 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004756
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004757 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4758 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4759 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4760 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4761 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4762 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4763
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004764 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4765 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4766 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4767 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4768 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4769 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4770 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4771 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4772
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004773 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4774 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4775 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4776 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4777 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004778
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004779 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4780 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4781
4782 Examples :
4783 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004784 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004785
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004786 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4787 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4788
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004789 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004790 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004791
4792 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004793 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004794
4795 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004796 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004797
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004798 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004799 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004800
4801
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004802http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004803 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4804 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004805 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4806 health checks.
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | no | yes | yes
4809 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004810 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4811
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004812 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4813 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4814 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4815 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4816 to invent non-standard ones.
4817
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004818 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4819 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4820 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4821 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4822
4823 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4824 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4825 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4826 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004827
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004828 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004829 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4830 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4831 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4832 to add it.
4833
4834 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4835 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4836 to the log-format rules.
4837
4838 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4839 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4840 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004841
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004842 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4843 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4844 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4845 request.
4846
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004847 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4848 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4849 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004850 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4851 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4852 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4853 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004854 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4855 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4856 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004858 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4859 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004860 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4861 so, it will be ignored.
4862
4863 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4864 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4865 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4866 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4867 configured request authority.
4868
4869 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4870 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004871
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004872 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004873
4874
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004875http-check send-state
4876 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 yes | no | yes | yes
4879 Arguments : none
4880
4881 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4882 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4883 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4884 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4885 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4886
4887 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4888 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4889 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4890 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4891 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004892 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4893 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4894 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4895
4896 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4897 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4898 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4899
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004900 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4901 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4902 checked in multiple backends.
4903
4904 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4905 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4906
4907 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4908 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4909 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4910 one fails.
4911
4912 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4913 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4914 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4915
4916 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4917 server's queue.
4918
4919 Example of a header received by the application server :
4920 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4921 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4922
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004923 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4924 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004925
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004926
4927http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004928 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 yes | no | yes | yes
4931
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004932 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004933 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4934 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4935 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4936 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4937 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4938 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4939 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4940 and '-'.
4941
4942 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4943
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004944 Examples :
4945 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004946
4947
4948http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004949 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | no | yes | yes
4952
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004953 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004954 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4955 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4958 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4959 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4960 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4961 and '-'.
4962
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004963 Examples :
4964 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004966
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004967http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
4968 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4969 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
4970 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
4971 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
4972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4973 yes | yes | yes | yes
4974 Arguments :
4975 staus <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
4976 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004977 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429,
4978 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004979
4980 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
4981 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
4982 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
4983 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
4984
4985 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
4986 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
4987 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
4988 a frontend, the default error message is used.
4989
4990 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
4991 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
4992 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
4993 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
4994 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
4995 chroot is performed.
4996
4997 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
4998 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
4999 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5000 considered.
5001
5002 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5003 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5004 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5005 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5006 considered as a raw string.
5007
5008 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5009 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5010 "content-type".
5011
5012 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5013 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5014 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5015 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5016 evaluated as a log-format string.
5017
5018 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5019 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5020 argument to "content-type".
5021
5022 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5023 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5024 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5025 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5026
5027 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5028 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5029 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5030 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5031 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5032 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5033 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5034 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5035
5036 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5037 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5038 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5039
5040 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5041 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5042
5043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005045 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5046
5047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 no | yes | yes | yes
5049
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005050 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5051 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5052 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5053 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5054 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005056 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5057 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005059 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005061 Example:
5062 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5063 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5064 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005066 http-request allow if nagios
5067 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5068 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5069 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005071 Example:
5072 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5073 acl add path /addacl
5074 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005076 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005078 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5079 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081 Example:
5082 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5083 acl setmap path /setmap
5084 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005088 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5089 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5092 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5097 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5098 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5099 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5100 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5101 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5102 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5103 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005105http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005107 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5108 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5109 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5110 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5111 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5112 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5113 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5114 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005116http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005118 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5119 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005120
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005122http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005124 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5125 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5126 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5127 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5128 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005129
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005130 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5131 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5132 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5133 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5134 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5135 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5136 instead.
5137
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005138 Example:
5139 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5140 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005141
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005142http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005143
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005144 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005146http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005149 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5150 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5151 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5152 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5153 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5154 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5155 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5156 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5157 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5160 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5161 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005162 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5163
5164 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5165 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5166 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5167 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005169http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005171 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5172 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5173 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5174 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5175 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5176 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005178http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005180 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005182http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005184 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5185 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5186 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5187 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5188 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5189 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005190
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005191http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5192http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5193 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5194 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5195 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5196 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005197
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5199 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5200 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
5201 return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined,
5202 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5203 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5204 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005205 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005206 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005207
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005208http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5209 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5210 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5211 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5212
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005213http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5214
5215 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5216 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5217 pointed by <resolvers>.
5218 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5219 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5220 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5221 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5222 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5223 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5224 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5225 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5226 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5227 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5228 to 0.0.0.0.
5229
5230 Example:
5231 resolvers mydns
5232 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5233 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5234 timeout retry 1s
5235 hold valid 10s
5236 hold nx 3s
5237 hold other 3s
5238 hold obsolete 0s
5239 accepted_payload_size 8192
5240
5241 frontend fe
5242 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5243 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5244 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5245
5246 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5247 # which mean DNS resolution error
5248 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5249
5250 default_backend be
5251
5252 backend b_503
5253 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5254 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5255 # 503 error page to end users
5256
5257 backend be
5258 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5259 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5260 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5261 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5262 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5263
5264 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5265 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5266
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005267http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5268
5269 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5270 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5271 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5272 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005273 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5274 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005275
5276 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005278http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005280 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5281 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5282 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5283 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5284 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005286http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5289 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5290 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5291 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005293http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5294 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005295
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005296 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005297 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5298 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5299 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5300 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5301 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005302
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005303 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5304 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5305 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5306 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5307 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005308
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005309 Example:
5310 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5311
5312 # applied to:
5313 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5314
5315 # outputs:
5316 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5317
5318 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005319
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005320 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5321
5322 # applied to:
5323 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005324
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005325 # outputs:
5326 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005327
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005328http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5329 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330
5331 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5332 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5333 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5334 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5335
5336 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5337 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5338 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5339
5340 Example:
5341 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5342 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5343
5344 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5345 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5346
5347 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5348 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5349 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5350 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5351
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005352http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5353 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5354
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005355 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5356 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5357 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5358 against.
5359
5360 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5361 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5362 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005363
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005364 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5365 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5366 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5367 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5368 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5369 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5370 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5371 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5372 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005373 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5374 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005375
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005376 Example:
5377 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5378 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005379
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005380 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5381 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005383http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005385
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005386 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5387 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5388 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5389 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005390
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005391 Example:
5392 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005393
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005394 # applied to:
5395 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005396
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005397 # outputs:
5398 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005399
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005400http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5401 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5402 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005403 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005404 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5405
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005406 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005407 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5408 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5409 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5410 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005411 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005412 are followed to create the response :
5413
5414 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5415 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5416 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5417 ignored.
5418
5419 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5420 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5421 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5422 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5423 ignored.
5424
5425 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5426 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5427 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5428 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5429 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5430
5431 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5432 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5433 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5434 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5435 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5436 if any, is ignored.
5437
5438 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5439 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5440 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5441 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5442 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5443 as a raw content.
5444
5445 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5446 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5447 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5448 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5449 considered as a raw string.
5450
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005451 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5452 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5453 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5454 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5455
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005456 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5457 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5458 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5459
5460 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5461
5462 Example:
5463 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5464 if { path /ping }
5465
5466 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5467 if { path /favicon.ico }
5468
5469 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5470 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5471 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5472
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005473http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5474http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005476 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5477 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5478 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005479
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005480http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5481 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005482
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005483 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5484 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5485 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5486 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005488http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005490 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5491 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5492 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5493 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5494 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005496 Arguments:
5497 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5498 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005500 Example:
5501 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5502 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005504 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5505 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005507http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005509 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5510 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5511 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005513 Arguments:
5514 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5515 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005517 Example:
5518 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5519 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005521 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5522 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5523 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005525http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005527 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5528 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5529 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5530 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5531 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005533 Example:
5534 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5535 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5536 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5537 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5538 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5539 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5540 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5541 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5542 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005544http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005546 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5547 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5548 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5549 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5550 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005552http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5553 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005555 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5556 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5557 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5558 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5559 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5560 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5561 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5562 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5563 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005565http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005567 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5568 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5569 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5570 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5571 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5572 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5573 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005575http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005577 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5578 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5579 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005583 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5584 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5585 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5586 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5587 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5588 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5589 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5590 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005594 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5595 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5596 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5597 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5598 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5599 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601 Example :
5602 # prepend the host name before the path
5603 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005605http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005607 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5608 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5609 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5610 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5611 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005615 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5616 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5617 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5618 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5619 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5620 values have higher priority.
5621 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5622 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5623 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5624 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5625 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5630 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5631 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5632 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5633 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5634 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5635 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005637 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005638
5639 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005640 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5641 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5644 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5645 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5646 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005647 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5648 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005649
5650 Arguments :
5651 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5652 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005653
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005654 See also "option forwardfor".
5655
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005656 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005657 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5658 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5659
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005660 # After the masking this will track connections
5661 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5662 http-request track-sc0 src
5663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005664 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5665 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5666
5667http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5668
5669 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5670 expression.
5671
5672 Arguments:
5673 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5674 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005675
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005676 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005677 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5678 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5679
5680 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5681 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5682 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5683
5684http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5685
5686 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5687 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5688 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5689 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5690 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5691 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5692 information from the request.
5693
5694 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5695
5696http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5697
5698 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5699 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5700 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5701 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5702 path and the query string.
5703 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5704
5705http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5706
5707 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5708 inline.
5709
5710 Arguments:
5711 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5712 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5713 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5714 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5715 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5716 (request and response)
5717 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5718 processing
5719 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5720 processing
5721 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5722 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5723 and '_'.
5724
5725 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5726 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005727
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005728 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005729 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005731http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5732 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005734 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5735 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5736 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5737 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5738 agent name must be used.
5739
5740 Arguments:
5741 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5742
5743 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5744 configuration.
5745
5746http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5747
5748 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5749 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5750 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5751 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5752 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5753 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5754 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5755 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5756 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5757 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5758 action.
5759 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5760 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5761 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5762 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5763 you fully understand how it works.
5764
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005765http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5766
5767 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5768 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5769 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5770 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5771 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005772 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005773 processing.
5774
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005775 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005776 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5777 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5778 rules evaluation.
5779
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005780http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5781http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5782 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5783 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5784 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5785 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005786
5787 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5788 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5789 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005790 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5791 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5792 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5793 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5794 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5795 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5796 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5797 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5798 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5799 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
5800 For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
5801 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5802 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5803 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5804 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5805 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005806
5807http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5808http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5809http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5810
5811 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5812 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5813 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5814 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5815 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5816 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5817 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5818 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5819 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5820 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5821 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5822 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5823
5824 Arguments :
5825 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5826 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5827 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5828 select which table entry to update the counters.
5829
5830 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5831 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5832 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5833 that table until the session ends.
5834
5835 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5836 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5837 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5838 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5839 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5840 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5841 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5842 useful information.
5843
5844 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5845 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5846 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5847 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5848 checks that make use of it.
5849
5850http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5851
5852 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005853
5854 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005856
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005857http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5858
5859 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5860 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5861 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5862 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5863 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5864 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5865
5866 Arguments :
5867 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5868
5869 Example:
5870 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005872http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005874 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5875 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5876 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005877
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005879http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005880 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5881
5882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 no | yes | yes | yes
5884
5885 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5886 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5887 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5888 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5889 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5890 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005892 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5893 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005895 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005897 Example:
5898 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005900 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005902 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5903 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005905 Example:
5906 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005908 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005910 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5911 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005913 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5914 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005916http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005918 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5919 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5920 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5921 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5922 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5923 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5924 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5925 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005927http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005929 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5930 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5931 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5932 example, or to pass some internal information.
5933 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5934 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5935 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005939 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5940 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005941
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005942http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005943
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005944 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005946http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005948 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5949 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5950 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5951 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5952 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5953 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5954 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005956 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5957 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5958 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5959 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5960 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005961
5962 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5963 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5964 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5965 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005967http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005969 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5970 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5971 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5972 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5973 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5974 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005976http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005978 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005980http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005982 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5983 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5984 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5985 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5986 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5987 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005988
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005989http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5990http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5991 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5992 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5993 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5994 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005995
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005996 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
5997 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5998 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
5999 "http-response return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no
6000 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6001 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6002 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006003 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006004 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006006http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006008 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6009 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6010 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6011 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6012 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6013 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006015http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006017
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006018 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6019 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006021 Example:
6022 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006024 # applied to:
6025 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006027 # outputs:
6028 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006030 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006032http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6033 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006034
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006035 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006036 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006038 Example:
6039 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006041 # applied to:
6042 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006044 # outputs:
6045 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006046
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006047http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6048 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6049 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006050 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6052
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006053 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006054 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6055 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6056 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6057 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006058 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006059 are followed to create the response :
6060
6061 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6062 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6063 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6064 ignored.
6065
6066 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6067 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
6068 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
6069 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6070 ignored.
6071
6072 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6073 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6074 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
6075 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
6076 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
6077
6078 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6079 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6080 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6081 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
6082 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
6083 if any, is ignored.
6084
6085 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6086 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6087 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6088 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6089 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6090 as a raw content.
6091
6092 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6093 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6094 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6095 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6096 considered as a raw string.
6097
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006098 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6099 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6100 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6101 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6102
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006103 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6104 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
6105 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
6106
6107 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6108
6109 Example:
6110 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6111 if { status eq 404 }
6112
6113 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6114 string "This is the end !" \
6115 if { status eq 500 }
6116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006117http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6118http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006120 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6121 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6122 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006123
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006124http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6125 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006126
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006127 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6128 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6129 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6130 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006132http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006134 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6135 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6136 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6137 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6138 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006140 Arguments:
6141 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006143 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6144 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006146http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006148 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6149 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6150 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006152http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6153
6154 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6155 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6156 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6157 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6158 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6159
6160http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6161
6162 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6163 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6164 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6165 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6166 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6167 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6168 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6169 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6170 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6171
6172http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6173
6174 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6175 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6176 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6177 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6178 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6179 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6180 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6181
6182http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6183
6184 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6185 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6186 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6187 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6188 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6189 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6190 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6191 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6192
6193http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6195
6196 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6197 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6198 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6199 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006200
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006201 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006202 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6203 http-response set-status 431
6204 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6205 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006207http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006209 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6210 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6211 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6212 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6213 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6214 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6215 based on some information from the request.
6216
6217 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6218
6219http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6220
6221 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6222 inline.
6223
6224 Arguments:
6225 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6226 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6227 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6228 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6229 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6230 (request and response)
6231 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6232 processing
6233 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6234 processing
6235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6236 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6237 and '_'.
6238
6239 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6240 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006241
6242 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006243 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006245http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006247 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6248 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6249 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6250 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6251 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6252 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6253 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6254 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6255 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6256 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6257 action.
6258 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6259 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6260 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6261 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6262 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006263
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006264http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6265
6266 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6267 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6268 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6269 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6270 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006271 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006272 processing.
6273
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006274 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006275 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6276 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6277 rules evaluation.
6278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006279http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6280http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6281http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006282
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006283 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6284 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6285 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6286 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6287 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6288 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6289
6290http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6291
6292 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6293 about <var-name>.
6294
6295 Example:
6296 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6297
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006298
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006299http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6300 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6301
6302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6303 yes | no | yes | yes
6304
6305 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006306 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6307 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6308 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006309
6310 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6311
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006312 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6313 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6314 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6315 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6316 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6317 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6318 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6319 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6320 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6321 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006322
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006323 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6324 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6325 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6326 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6327 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6328 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6329 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6330 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006331
6332 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6333 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6334 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6335 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6336 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6337 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6338 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6339 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006340 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006341 downsides of rare connection failures.
6342
6343 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6344 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6345 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6346 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6347 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6348 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006349 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006350 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6351 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6352 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6353 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6354 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6355
6356 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006357 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6358 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6359 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006360
6361 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006362 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006363
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006364 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6365 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006366
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006367 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006368
6369 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6370 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6371 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6372
6373 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6374
6375
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006376http-send-name-header [<header>]
6377 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6379 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006380 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006381 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6382
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006383 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6384 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6385 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6386 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6387 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6388 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6389 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6390 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6391 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6392 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6393 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6394 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6395 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6396 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6397 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6398 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006399
6400 See also : "server"
6401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006402id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006403 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 no | yes | yes | yes
6406 Arguments : none
6407
6408 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6409 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6410 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006411
6412
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006413ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6414 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6415 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006416 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006417
6418 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6419 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6420 and running).
6421
6422 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6423 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6424 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006425 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006426 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6427
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006428 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6429 "unless" condition is met.
6430
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006431 Example:
6432 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6433 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6434 ignore-persist if url_static
6435
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006436 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6437
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006438load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6439 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6441 yes | no | yes | yes
6442
6443 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6444 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6445 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006446 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006447 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6448 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6449 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6450 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6451
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006452 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006453 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006454 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006455
6456 Arguments:
6457 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6458 named "server-state-file".
6459
6460 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6461 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6462 name is used as a file name.
6463
6464 none don't load any stat for this backend
6465
6466 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006467 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6468 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6469 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006470 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006471 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006472
6473 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6474 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6475
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006476 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006477
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006478 global
6479 stats socket /tmp/socket
6480 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006481
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006482 defaults
6483 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006484
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006485 backend bk
6486 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6487 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006488
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006489
6490 Then one can run :
6491
6492 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6493
6494 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6495
6496 1
6497 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6498 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6499 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6500
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006501 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006502
6503 global
6504 stats socket /tmp/socket
6505 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6506
6507 defaults
6508 load-server-state-from-file local
6509
6510 backend bk
6511 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6512 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6513
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006514
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006515 Then one can run :
6516
6517 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6518
6519 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6520
6521 1
6522 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6523 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6524 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6525
6526 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6527 "show servers state"
6528
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006529
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006530log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006531log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6532 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006533no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006534 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006537
6538 Prefix :
6539 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6540 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6541 prefix does not allow arguments.
6542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006543 Arguments :
6544 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6545 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6546 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6547 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6548 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6549 parameter.
6550
6551 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6552 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6553
6554 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6555 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6556 standard syslog port).
6557
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006558 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6559 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6560 standard syslog port).
6561
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006562 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6563 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6564 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006565 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006566
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006567 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6568 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6569 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6570 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6571 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6572 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6573 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6574 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6575 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6576 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6577 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6578 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6579 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6580 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6581 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6582 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006583 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6584 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006585
6586 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6587 and "fd@2", see above.
6588
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006589 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6590 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6591 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6592 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6593 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6594 having the logs instantly available.
6595
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006596 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6597 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006598
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006599 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6600 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6601 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6602 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6603 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6604 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6605 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6606 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6607 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6608 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006609 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006610
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006611 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6612 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6613 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6614 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6615 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6616
6617 <sample_size>
6618 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6619 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6620 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6621 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6622 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6623
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006624 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6625 one of the following :
6626
6627 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6628 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6629
6630 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6631 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6632
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006633 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6634 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6635 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6636 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6637 systemd logger consumes.
6638
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006639 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6640 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6641 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6642 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6643
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006644 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6645
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006646 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6647 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6648 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6649
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006650 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6651 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6652 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6653 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006654
6655 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6656 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6657 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006658 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6659 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6660 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6661 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6662 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006663
6664 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6665
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006666 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6667 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6668 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006669
6670 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6671 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6672 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6673 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6674
6675 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6676 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006677
6678 Example :
6679 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006680 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6681 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6682 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006683 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6684 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006685 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006687
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006688log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006689 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006692
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006693 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6694 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6695 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6696 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6697 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006698
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006699 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6700 "option httplog" directives.
6701
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006702log-format-sd <string>
6703 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6705 yes | yes | yes | no
6706
6707 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6708 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6709 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6710 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6711 which covers the log format string in depth.
6712
6713 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6714 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6715
6716 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6717 log format to "rfc5424".
6718
6719 Example :
6720 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6721
6722
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006723log-tag <string>
6724 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | yes | yes | yes
6727
6728 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6729 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6730 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6731 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6732 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6733 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6734 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6735 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6736 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006737
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006738max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6739 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6741 yes | no | yes | yes
6742
6743 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6744 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6745 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6746 servers.
6747
6748 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6749 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6750 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6751 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6752 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006753 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006754 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6755 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6756 picking a different server.
6757
6758 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6759 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6760 even if they have to be queued.
6761
6762 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6763 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6764
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006765max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6766 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6767 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6768 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006769
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006770maxconn <conns>
6771 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | yes | yes | no
6774 Arguments :
6775 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6776 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6777 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6778 closes.
6779
6780 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6781 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6782 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6783 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006784 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6785 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6786 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6787 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006788
6789 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6790 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6791 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6792
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006793 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6794 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006795
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006796 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6797
6798
6799mode { tcp|http|health }
6800 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6802 yes | yes | yes | yes
6803 Arguments :
6804 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6805 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6806 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6807 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6808
6809 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6810 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6811 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6812 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6813 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6814
6815 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006816 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6817 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6818 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6819 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6820 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6821 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6822 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006823
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006824 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6825 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6826 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006827
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006828 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006829 defaults http_instances
6830 mode http
6831
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006832 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006834
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006835monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006836 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006839 Arguments :
6840 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6841 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006842 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006843 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6844 backend and its backup.
6845
6846 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6847 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6848 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6849 servers in a list of backends.
6850
6851 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6852 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6853 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6854 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6855 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6856 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6857 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006858 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6859 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006860
6861 Example:
6862 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006863 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006864 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6865 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6866 monitor-uri /site_alive
6867 monitor fail if site_dead
6868
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006869 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006870
6871
6872monitor-net <source>
6873 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6875 yes | yes | yes | no
6876 Arguments :
6877 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6878 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6879 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6880 followed by a mask.
6881
6882 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6883 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006884 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006885 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6886
6887 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6888 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6889 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6890 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006891 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6892 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6893 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006894
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006895 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6896 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6897 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6898 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6899 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6900 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006901
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006902 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6903 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006905 Example :
6906 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6907 frontend www
6908 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6909
6910 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6911
6912
6913monitor-uri <uri>
6914 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6916 yes | yes | yes | no
6917 Arguments :
6918 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6919 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6920
6921 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6922 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6923 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6924 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6925 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6926 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6927 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6928 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6929
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006930 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006931 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6932 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6933 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6934 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6935 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6936 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006937
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006938 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6939 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6940 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6941 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006943 Example :
6944 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6945 frontend www
6946 mode http
6947 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6948
6949 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006951
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006952option abortonclose
6953no option abortonclose
6954 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6956 yes | no | yes | yes
6957 Arguments : none
6958
6959 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6960 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6961 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6962 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006963 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006964 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6965 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6966 encountered while delivering the response.
6967
6968 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6969 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6970 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6971 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6972 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6973 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006974 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006975 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006976 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006977 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6978 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6979 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006981 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6982 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006983 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6984 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6985 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6986 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6987 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6988 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006989 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006990
6991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6993
6994 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6995
6996
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006997option accept-invalid-http-request
6998no option accept-invalid-http-request
6999 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | yes | yes | no
7002 Arguments : none
7003
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007004 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007005 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007006 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007007 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7008 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7009 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7010 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7011 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007012 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7013 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7014 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7015 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007016 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007017 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007018 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7019 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7020 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007021
7022 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7023 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7024 been confirmed.
7025
7026 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7027 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007028 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7029 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007030 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7031
7032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7034
7035 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7036 stats socket.
7037
7038
7039option accept-invalid-http-response
7040no option accept-invalid-http-response
7041 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7043 yes | no | yes | yes
7044 Arguments : none
7045
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007046 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007047 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007048 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007049 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7050 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7051 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7052 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7053 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007054 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7055 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7056 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007057
7058 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7059 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7060 been confirmed.
7061
7062 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7063 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7064 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7065 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7066
7067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7069
7070 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7071 stats socket.
7072
7073
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007074option allbackups
7075no option allbackups
7076 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7078 yes | no | yes | yes
7079 Arguments : none
7080
7081 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7082 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7083 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7084 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7085 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7086 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7087 order between the backup servers anymore.
7088
7089 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7090 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7091
7092 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7093 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7094
7095
7096option checkcache
7097no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007098 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7100 yes | no | yes | yes
7101 Arguments : none
7102
7103 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7104 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007105 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007106 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7107 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007108 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007109
7110 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007111 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007112 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007113 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7114 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007115 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007116 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007117 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7118 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007119 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007120 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7121 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007122 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007123 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7124 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7125 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7126 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7127 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7128 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7129 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7130 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7131 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7132
7133 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007134 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7135 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7136 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7137 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007138
7139 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7140 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007141 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007142 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007143
7144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7146
7147
7148option clitcpka
7149no option clitcpka
7150 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7152 yes | yes | yes | no
7153 Arguments : none
7154
7155 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7156 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007157 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007158 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7159
7160 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7161 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7162 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7163 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7164
7165 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7166 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7167 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7168 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7169 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7170
7171 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7172
7173 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7174 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7175 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7176
7177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7179
7180 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7181
7182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007183option contstats
7184 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7186 yes | yes | yes | no
7187 Arguments : none
7188
7189 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7190 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7191 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7192 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007193 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7194 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7195 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7196 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7197 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007198
7199
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007200option dontlog-normal
7201no option dontlog-normal
7202 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7204 yes | yes | yes | no
7205 Arguments : none
7206
7207 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7208 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7209 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7210 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7211 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7212 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7213 logged.
7214
7215 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7216 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7217 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007219 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007220 logging.
7221
7222
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007223option dontlognull
7224no option dontlognull
7225 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7227 yes | yes | yes | no
7228 Arguments : none
7229
7230 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7231 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7232 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7233 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7234 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7235 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007236 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7237 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7238 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007239
7240 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007241 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007242 would not be logged.
7243
7244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7246
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007247 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7248 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007249
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007250
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007251option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007252 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7254 yes | yes | yes | yes
7255 Arguments :
7256 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7257 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007258 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007259 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007260
7261 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7262 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7263 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7264 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7265 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7266 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7267 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007268 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7269 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7270 possible that the client has already brought one.
7271
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007272 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007273 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007274 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007275 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007276 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007277 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007278
7279 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7280 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7281 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7282 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7283 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7284 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7285 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7286
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007287 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7288 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7289 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7290 are under the control of the end-user.
7291
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007292 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007293 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7294 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007295 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7296 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7297 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007298
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007299 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007300 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7301 frontend www
7302 mode http
7303 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7304
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007305 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7306 backend www
7307 mode http
7308 option forwardfor header X-Client
7309
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007310 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007311 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007312
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007313
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007314option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7315no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7316 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | yes | yes | no
7319 Arguments : none
7320
7321 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7322 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7323 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7324 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7325 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7326 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7327 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7328
7329 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7330 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7331 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7332 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7333 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7334 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7335 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7336 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7337 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7338 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7339
7340 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7341
7342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7344
7345 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7346 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7347
7348
7349option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7350no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7351 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7353 yes | no | yes | yes
7354 Arguments : none
7355
7356 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7357 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7358 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7359 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7360 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7361 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7362 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7363
7364 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7365 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7366 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7367 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7368 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7369 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7370 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7371 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7372 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7373 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7374
7375 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7376
7377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7379
7380 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7381 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7382
7383
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007384option http-buffer-request
7385no option http-buffer-request
7386 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 yes | yes | yes | yes
7389 Arguments : none
7390
7391 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7392 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7393 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7394 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7395 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7396 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007397 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7398 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7399 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7400 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007401
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007402 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007403
7404
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007405option http-ignore-probes
7406no option http-ignore-probes
7407 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | yes | yes | no
7410 Arguments : none
7411
7412 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7413 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7414 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7415 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7416 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7417 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7418 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7419 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7420 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007421 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7422 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007423 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7424
7425 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7426 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7427 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7428 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7429 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7430 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7431 are often the only way to detect them.
7432
7433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7435
7436 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7437
7438
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007439option http-keep-alive
7440no option http-keep-alive
7441 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 yes | yes | yes | yes
7444 Arguments : none
7445
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007446 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7447 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007448 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7449 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007450 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7451 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7452 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007453
7454 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7455 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007456 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7457 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7458 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7459 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7460 situations where this option may be useful :
7461
7462 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007463 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007464
7465 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7466 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7467
7468 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7469 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7470 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7471 request.
7472
7473 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7474 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007475 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7476 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7477 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007478
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007479 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7480 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7481 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7482 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7483 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7484 not set.
7485
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007486 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7487 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7488 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007489
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007490 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007491 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007492 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007493
7494
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007495option http-no-delay
7496no option http-no-delay
7497 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 yes | yes | yes | yes
7500 Arguments : none
7501
7502 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7503 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7504 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7505 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7506 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7507 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7508 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7509 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7510 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7511 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7512 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7513 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7514 affected.
7515
7516 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7517 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7518 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7519 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7520 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7521 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7522 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7523 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7524 latency environments.
7525
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007526 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7527
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007528
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007529option http-pretend-keepalive
7530no option http-pretend-keepalive
7531 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007533 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007534 Arguments : none
7535
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007536 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007537 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7538 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7539 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7540 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7541 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7542 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7543 consider the response complete.
7544
7545 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7546 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7547 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7548 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007549 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007550 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7551
7552 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7553 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7554 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7555 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7556 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7557 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7558 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7559
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007560 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7561 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7562 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7563 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7564 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7565 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007566
7567 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7568 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7569
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007570 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007571 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007572
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007573
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007574option http-server-close
7575no option http-server-close
7576 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7578 yes | yes | yes | yes
7579 Arguments : none
7580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007581 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7582 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7583 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7584 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007585 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7586 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7587 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7588 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7589 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7590 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7591 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7592 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7593 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7594 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7595 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007596
7597 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7598 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7599 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7600 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007601 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7602 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007603
7604 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7605 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007606 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7607 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7608 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007609
7610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7612
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007613 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7614 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007615
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007616option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007617no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007618 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 yes | yes | yes | no
7621 Arguments : none
7622
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007623 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007624 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7625 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7626 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7627 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7628 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7629 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7630
7631 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7632 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007633 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7634 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7635 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007636
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007637 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7638 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7639 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7640 front of an existing proxy.
7641
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007642 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7643
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007644 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007646option httpchk
7647option httpchk <uri>
7648option httpchk <method> <uri>
7649option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007650 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7652 yes | no | yes | yes
7653 Arguments :
7654 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7655 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7656 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7657 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7658 ones.
7659
7660 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7661 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7662 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7663
7664 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7665 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7666 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007667 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007668
7669 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7670 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7671 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7672 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7673 the lack of any response.
7674
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007675 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7676 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7677 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7678 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7679
7680 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7681 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7682 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007683
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007684 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7685 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007686 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7687 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7688 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007689
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007690 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7691 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7692 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7693 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7694
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007695 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007696 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7697 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7698 backend https_relay
7699 mode tcp
7700 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7701 http-check send hdr Host www
7702 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007703
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007704 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7705 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7706 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007707
7708
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007709option httpclose
7710no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007711 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 yes | yes | yes | yes
7714 Arguments : none
7715
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007716 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7717 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7718 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7719 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007720 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007721
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007722 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7723 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007724 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007725 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7726 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007727
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007728 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7729 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7730 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007731
7732 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7733 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007734 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7735 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7736 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007737
7738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7740
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007741 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007742
7743
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007744option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007745 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007747 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007748 Arguments :
7749 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7750 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7751 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007752 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007753 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007754
7755 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7756 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7757 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7758 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7759 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7760 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7761 ports.
7762
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007763 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7764 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007765
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007766 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007768 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007769
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007770
7771option http_proxy
7772no option http_proxy
7773 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7775 yes | yes | yes | yes
7776 Arguments : none
7777
7778 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7779 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7780 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7781 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7782 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7783
7784 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7785 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007786 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7787 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007788
7789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7791
7792 Example :
7793 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7794 backend direct_forward
7795 option httpclose
7796 option http_proxy
7797
7798 See also : "option httpclose"
7799
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007800
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007801option independent-streams
7802no option independent-streams
7803 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7805 yes | yes | yes | yes
7806 Arguments : none
7807
7808 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7809 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7810 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7811 receive data or not.
7812
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007813 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007814 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7815 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7816 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7817 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7818 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7819 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7820 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7821 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7822 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7823 socket buffers.
7824
7825 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7826 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7827 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7828 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7829 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7830
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007831 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007832
7833
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007834option ldap-check
7835 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7837 yes | no | yes | yes
7838 Arguments : none
7839
7840 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7841 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7842 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7843 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7844
7845 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7846 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7847
7848 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7849 configure it.
7850
7851 Example :
7852 option ldap-check
7853
7854 See also : "option httpchk"
7855
7856
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007857option external-check
7858 Use external processes for server health checks
7859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7860 yes | no | yes | yes
7861
7862 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7863 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7864 command".
7865
7866 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7867
7868 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7869
7870
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007871option log-health-checks
7872no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007873 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 yes | no | yes | yes
7876 Arguments : none
7877
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007878 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7879 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7880 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007881
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007882 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7883 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7884 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7885 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7886 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7887
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007888 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007889 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007890
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007891 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7892 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7893 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007894
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007895
7896option log-separate-errors
7897no option log-separate-errors
7898 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | yes | yes | no
7901 Arguments : none
7902
7903 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7904 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7905 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7906 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7907 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7908 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7909 provides very important information.
7910
7911 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7912 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7913 error logs.
7914
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007915 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007916 logging.
7917
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007918
7919option logasap
7920no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007921 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7923 yes | yes | yes | no
7924 Arguments : none
7925
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007926 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7927 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7928 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7929 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7930
7931 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7932 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7933 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7934 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7935 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007936 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007937 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7938 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7939 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7940 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007941 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007942
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007943 Examples :
7944 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7945 mode http
7946 option httplog
7947 option logasap
7948 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7949
7950 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7951 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7952 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7953 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007955 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007956 logging.
7957
7958
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007959option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007960 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007963 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007964 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7965 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007966 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
7967 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007968
7969 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7970 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007971 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007972 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7973 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7974 in the MySQL table, like this :
7975
7976 USE mysql;
7977 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7978 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7979
7980 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007982 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7983 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7984 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7985 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7986 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7987 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7988 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7989
7990 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7991 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007992
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007993 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007994
7995 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7996 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7997 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7998 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007999 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8000 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008001
8002 See also: "option httpchk"
8003
8004
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008005option nolinger
8006no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008007 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8009 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008010 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008011
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008012 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008013 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8014 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8015 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8016 connections.
8017
8018 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8019 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8020 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8021 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8022 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8023 this too.
8024
8025 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8026 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8027 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8028
8029 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8030 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8031 for servers.
8032
8033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8035
8036
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008037option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8038 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8040 yes | yes | yes | yes
8041 Arguments :
8042 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8043 matching <network>
8044 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8045 header name.
8046
8047 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8048 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8049 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8050 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8051 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8052 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8053 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8054 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8055 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8056 possible that the client has already brought one.
8057
8058 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8059 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8060 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8061 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8062 header and requires different one.
8063
8064 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8065 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8066 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8067 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8068 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8069 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8070 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8071
8072 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8073 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8074 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8075 both are defined.
8076
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008077 Examples :
8078 # Original Destination address
8079 frontend www
8080 mode http
8081 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8082
8083 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8084 backend www
8085 mode http
8086 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8087
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008088 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008089
8090
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008091option persist
8092no option persist
8093 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8095 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008096 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008097
8098 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8099 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8100 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8101 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8102 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8103 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8104 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8105 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8106 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8107 redirected to another valid server.
8108
8109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8111
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008112 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008113
8114
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008115option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8116 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 yes | no | yes | yes
8119 Arguments :
8120 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8121 PostgreSQL server.
8122
8123 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8124 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8125 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8126 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8127
8128 See also: "option httpchk"
8129
8130
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008131option prefer-last-server
8132no option prefer-last-server
8133 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8135 yes | no | yes | yes
8136 Arguments : none
8137
8138 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8139 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8140 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8141 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8142 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8143 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8144 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8145 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8146 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008147 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8148 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008149 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8150 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8151 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008152 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8153 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8154 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008155
8156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8158
8159 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8160
8161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008162option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008163option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008164no option redispatch
8165 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008168 Arguments :
8169 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8170 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8171 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008172 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008173 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008174 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008175 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8176 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8177 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008179
8180 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8181 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8182 be able to access the service anymore.
8183
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008184 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8185 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008186
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008187 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8188 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8189 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8190 following order:
8191
8192 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8193
8194 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8195 list, or
8196
8197 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8198
8199 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8200 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8201
8202 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8203 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8204 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8205 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8206
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008207 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008208 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8209 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8213
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008214 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008215
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008216
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008217option redis-check
8218 Use redis health checks for server testing
8219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8220 yes | no | yes | yes
8221 Arguments : none
8222
8223 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8224 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8225 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8226 find the "+PONG" response message.
8227
8228 Example :
8229 option redis-check
8230
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008231 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008232
8233
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008234option smtpchk
8235option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8236 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8238 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008239 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008240 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008241 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008242 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8243
8244 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8245 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8246 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8247
8248 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8249 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8250 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8251 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8252 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8253 dead server.
8254
8255 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8256 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008257 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008258 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8259
8260 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8261 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8262 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8263 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008264 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008265
8266 Example :
8267 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8268
8269 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008272option socket-stats
8273no option socket-stats
8274
8275 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8277 yes | yes | yes | no
8278
8279 Arguments : none
8280
8281
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008282option splice-auto
8283no option splice-auto
8284 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8286 yes | yes | yes | yes
8287 Arguments : none
8288
8289 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8290 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008291 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008292 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008293 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008294 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8295 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8296 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8297 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8298
8299 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8300 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8301 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8302 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8303 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8304 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8305 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8306 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8307 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8308 keyword.
8309
8310 Example :
8311 option splice-auto
8312
8313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8315
8316 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8317 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8318
8319
8320option splice-request
8321no option splice-request
8322 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8324 yes | yes | yes | yes
8325 Arguments : none
8326
8327 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008328 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008329 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8330 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8331 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8332 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8333
8334 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8335
8336 Example :
8337 option splice-request
8338
8339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8341
8342 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8343 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8344
8345
8346option splice-response
8347no option splice-response
8348 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8350 yes | yes | yes | yes
8351 Arguments : none
8352
8353 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008354 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008355 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8356 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8357 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8358 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8359
8360 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8361
8362 Example :
8363 option splice-response
8364
8365 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8366 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8367
8368 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8369 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8370
8371
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008372option spop-check
8373 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8375 no | no | no | yes
8376 Arguments : none
8377
8378 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8379 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8380 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8381 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8382
8383 Example :
8384 option spop-check
8385
8386 See also : "option httpchk"
8387
8388
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008389option srvtcpka
8390no option srvtcpka
8391 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8393 yes | no | yes | yes
8394 Arguments : none
8395
8396 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8397 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008398 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008399 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8400
8401 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8402 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8403 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8404 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8405
8406 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8407 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8408 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8409 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8410 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8411
8412 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8413
8414 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8415 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8416 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8417
8418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8420
8421 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8422
8423
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008424option ssl-hello-chk
8425 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8427 yes | no | yes | yes
8428 Arguments : none
8429
8430 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8431 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8432 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8433 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8434 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8435 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8436 hello message.
8437
8438 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8439 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8440 messages, which is appreciable.
8441
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008442 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8443 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8444 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008445
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008446 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8447
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008448
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008449option tcp-check
8450 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8451 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8452 yes | no | yes | yes
8453
8454 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8455 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8456
8457 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8458 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8459 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8460
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008461 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008462 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8463 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8464 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8465 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8466 only.
8467
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008468 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008469 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8470 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8471 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8472 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8473
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008474 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008475 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8476 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008477 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008478 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8479 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8480 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8481 the respective protocols.
8482 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008483 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008484
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008485 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008486
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008487 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8488 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8489 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8490 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008491
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008492 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8493 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8494 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008495
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008496
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008497 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008498 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008499 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008500 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008502 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008503 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008504 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008505
8506 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8507 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008508 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008509 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008510 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008511 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008512 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008513 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008514 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8515 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008516 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008517 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8518 tcp-check expect string +OK
8519
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008520 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008521 (send many headers before analyzing)
8522 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008523 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008524 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8525 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8526 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8527 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008528 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008529
8530
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008531 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008532
8533
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008534option tcp-smart-accept
8535no option tcp-smart-accept
8536 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | yes | yes | no
8539 Arguments : none
8540
8541 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8542 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8543 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8544 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8545 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8546 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8547
8548 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8549 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8550 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8551 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8552
8553 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8554 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8555 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008557
8558 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8559 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8560 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8561
8562 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8563 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8564 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8565
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008566 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8567
8568
8569option tcp-smart-connect
8570no option tcp-smart-connect
8571 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8573 yes | no | yes | yes
8574 Arguments : none
8575
8576 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8577 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8578 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8579 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8580 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8581
8582 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8583 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8584 complex.
8585
8586 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8587 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8588 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8589
8590 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8591 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8592
8593 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8594
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008595
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008596option tcpka
8597 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8599 yes | yes | yes | yes
8600 Arguments : none
8601
8602 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8603 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008604 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008605 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8606
8607 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8608 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8609 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8610 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8611
8612 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8613 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8614 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8615 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8616 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8617
8618 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8619
8620 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8621 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8622 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8623 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8624 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8625 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8626 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8627 backends.
8628
8629 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8630
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008631
8632option tcplog
8633 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008635 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008636 Arguments : none
8637
8638 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8639 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8640 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8641 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8642 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8643 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8644 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8645 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8646
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008647 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008649 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008650
8651
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008652option transparent
8653no option transparent
8654 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008656 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008657 Arguments : none
8658
8659 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8660 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8661 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8662 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8663 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8664 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8665 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8666 appropriate server.
8667
8668 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8669 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8670
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008671 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008672 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008673
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008674
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008675external-check command <command>
8676 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8678 yes | no | yes | yes
8679
8680 Arguments :
8681 <command> is the external command to run
8682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008683 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8684
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008685 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008686
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008687 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8688 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8689 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8690 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8691 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8692 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008693
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008694 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8695
8696 Environment variables :
8697 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8698 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8699
8700 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8701
8702 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8703
8704 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8705 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8706 for a UNIX socket).
8707
8708 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8709
8710 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8711
8712 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8713
8714 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8715
8716 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8717
8718 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8719 socket).
8720
8721 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8722 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8723
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008724 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8725
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008726 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8727 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8728 failed.
8729
8730 Example :
8731 external-check command /bin/true
8732
8733 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8734
8735
8736external-check path <path>
8737 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8739 yes | no | yes | yes
8740
8741 Arguments :
8742 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8743
8744 The default path is "".
8745
8746 Example :
8747 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8748
8749 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8750 "external-check command"
8751
8752
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008753persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008754persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008755 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8757 yes | no | yes | yes
8758 Arguments :
8759 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008760 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8761 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008762
8763 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8764 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008765 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008766 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8767 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8768 forwarded to this server.
8769
8770 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8771 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8772 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008773 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008774 a single "listen" section.
8775
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008776 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8777 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8778 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8779
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008780 Example :
8781 listen tse-farm
8782 bind :3389
8783 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8784 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8785 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8786 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8787 persist rdp-cookie
8788 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008789 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008790 balance rdp-cookie
8791 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8792 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8793
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008794 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8795 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008796
8797
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008798rate-limit sessions <rate>
8799 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8801 yes | yes | yes | no
8802 Arguments :
8803 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8804 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8805
8806 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8807 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8808 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8809 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8810 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8811 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8812
8813 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8814 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8815 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8816 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8817
8818 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8819 listen smtp
8820 mode tcp
8821 bind :25
8822 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008823 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008824
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008825 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8826 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8827 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008828
8829 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8830
8831
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008832redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8833redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8834redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008835 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8837 no | yes | yes | yes
8838
8839 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008840 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008841
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008842 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008843 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008844 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8845 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8846 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008847
8848 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8849 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8850 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8851 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8852 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008853 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8854 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8855 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8856 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008857
8858 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8859 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8860 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8861 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8862 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8863 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008864 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008865 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008866 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8867 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8868 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008869
8870 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008871 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8872 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8873 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008874 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008875 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8876 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8877 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8878 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008879
8880 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008881 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008882
8883 - "drop-query"
8884 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8885 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8886 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8887 with a location-type redirect.
8888
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008889 - "append-slash"
8890 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8891 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8892 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8893 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8894
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008895 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8896 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8897 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8898 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8899 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8900 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8901 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8902
8903 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8904 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8905 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8906 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8907 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8908 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8909 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008910
8911 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8912 acl clear dst_port 80
8913 acl secure dst_port 8080
8914 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008915 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008916 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008917 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8918
8919 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008920 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8921 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8922 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008923 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008924
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008925 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8926 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8927 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8928
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008929 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008930 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008931
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008932 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008933 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8934 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8935 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008937 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008938
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008939
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008940retries <value>
8941 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8943 yes | no | yes | yes
8944 Arguments :
8945 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8946 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8947 default value is 3.
8948
8949 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8950 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8951 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8952
8953 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008954 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8955 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008956
8957 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8958 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8959
8960 See also : "option redispatch"
8961
8962
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008963retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02008964 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
8965 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
8966 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8968 yes | no | yes | yes
8969 Arguments :
8970 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8971 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8972 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8973 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8974
8975 none never retry
8976
8977 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8978 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8979
8980 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8981 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8982 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8983 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8984 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8985 processing the request.
8986
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008987 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8988 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8989 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8990 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8991 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8992 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8993 overflow attack for example).
8994
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008995 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8996 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8997 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8998 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8999 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9000 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9001 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9002 amplify denial of service attacks.
9003
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009004 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9005 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9006 considered to be safe to retry.
9007
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009008 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9009 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9010 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9011 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9012
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009013 all-retryable-errors
9014 retry request for any error that are considered
9015 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9016 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9017 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9018
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009019 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9020 not cumulative.
9021
9022 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9023 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9024 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9025 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9026
9027 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9028 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9029 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9030 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9031 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9032 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9033 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9034 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9035 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9036 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9037 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9038 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9039
9040 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9041 should not use this directive.
9042
9043 The default is "conn-failure".
9044
9045 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9046
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009047server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009048 Declare a server in a backend
9049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 no | no | yes | yes
9051 Arguments :
9052 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009053 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009054 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009055
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009056 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9057 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9058 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9059 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009060 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9061 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9062 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9063 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9064 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009065 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9066 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9067 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9068 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9069 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9070 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9071 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009072 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009073 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9074 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9075 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9076 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9077 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9078 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009079 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9080 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009081 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9082 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009084 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009085 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9086 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9087 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9088 adding this value to the client's port.
9089
9090 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9091 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009092 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009093
9094 Examples :
9095 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9096 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009097 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009098 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9099 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9100 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009101
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009102 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9103 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9104 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9105 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9106 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9107
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009108 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9109 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009110
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009111server-state-file-name [<file>]
9112 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9113 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9114 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9115 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9116 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9117 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9118
9119 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9120 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9121
9122 global
9123 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9124
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009125 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009126 load-server-state-from-file
9127
9128 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9129 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009130
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009131server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9132 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9133 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 no | no | yes | yes
9136
9137 Arguments:
9138 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9139
9140 <num | range>
9141 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9142 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9143 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9144 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9145
9146 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9147
9148 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9149
9150 <params*>
9151 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9152 keyword.
9153
9154 Examples:
9155 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9156 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9157 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9158
9159 # or
9160 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9161
9162 # would be equivalent to:
9163 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9164 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9165 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9166
9167
9168
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009169source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009170source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009171source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009172 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9174 yes | no | yes | yes
9175 Arguments :
9176 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9177 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009178
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009179 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009180 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9181 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9182 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9183 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9184 supported prefixes are :
9185 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9186 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9187 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009188 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009189 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9190 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009191
9192 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9193 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009194 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9195 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9196 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009197
9198 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9199 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9200 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9201 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9202 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9203 <addr>.
9204
9205 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9206 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9207 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9208 port.
9209
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009210 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9211 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9212 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9213 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009214 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009215 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9216 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9217 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9218 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9219 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9220 HTTP header.
9221
9222 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9223 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009224 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009225 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9226 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9227 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9228 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9229 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9230 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9231 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9232
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009233 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9234 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9235 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9236 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9237 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9238 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9239
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009240 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9241 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9242 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9243 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9244
9245 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9246 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9247 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9248 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9249 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9250 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9251
9252 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9253 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9254 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9255 there are two methods :
9256
9257 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9258 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9259 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9260 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9261 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9262 of the client ranges may be used.
9263
9264 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9265 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9266 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9267 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9268 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9269 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9270 same session.
9271
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009272 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9273 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9274 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009275 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009276
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009277 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9278
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009279 Examples :
9280 backend private
9281 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9282 source 192.168.1.200
9283
9284 backend transparent_ssl1
9285 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9286 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9287
9288 backend transparent_ssl2
9289 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9290 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9291 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9292
9293 backend transparent_ssl3
9294 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9295 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9296 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9297
9298 backend transparent_smtp
9299 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9300 # with Tproxy version 4.
9301 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9302
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009303 backend transparent_http
9304 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9305 # proxy.
9306 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009308 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009309 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9310
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009311
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009312stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9313 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009315 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009316
9317 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9318 matched.
9319
9320 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9321 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9322
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009323 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9324 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009325 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009326
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009327 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9328 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9329 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9330 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009331
9332 Example :
9333 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9334 backend stats_localhost
9335 stats enable
9336 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9337
9338 Example :
9339 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9340 backend stats_auth
9341 stats enable
9342 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9343 stats admin if TRUE
9344
9345 Example :
9346 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9347 userlist stats-auth
9348 group admin users admin
9349 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9350 group readonly users haproxy
9351 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9352
9353 backend stats_auth
9354 stats enable
9355 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9356 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9357 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9358 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9359
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009360 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9361 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9362 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009363
9364
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009365stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9366 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009368 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009369 Arguments :
9370 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9371
9372 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9373
9374 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9375 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9376 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9377 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9378 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9379 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9380
9381 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9382 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9383 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009384 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009385
9386 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9387 report using "stats scope".
9388
9389 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9390 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9391 unobvious parameters.
9392
9393 Example :
9394 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9395 backend public_www
9396 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9397 stats enable
9398 stats hide-version
9399 stats scope .
9400 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009401 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009402 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9403 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9404
9405 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9406 backend private_monitoring
9407 stats enable
9408 stats uri /admin?stats
9409 stats refresh 5s
9410
9411 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9412
9413
9414stats enable
9415 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009417 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009418 Arguments : none
9419
9420 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9421 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9422 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9423 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9424 - stats auth : no authentication
9425 - stats scope : no restriction
9426
9427 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9428 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9429 unobvious parameters.
9430
9431 Example :
9432 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9433 backend public_www
9434 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9435 stats enable
9436 stats hide-version
9437 stats scope .
9438 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009439 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009440 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9441 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9442
9443 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9444 backend private_monitoring
9445 stats enable
9446 stats uri /admin?stats
9447 stats refresh 5s
9448
9449 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9450
9451
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009452stats hide-version
9453 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009455 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009456 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009457
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009458 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9459 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9460 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9461 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9462 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9463 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009465 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9466 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9467 unobvious parameters.
9468
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009469 Example :
9470 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9471 backend public_www
9472 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009473 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009474 stats hide-version
9475 stats scope .
9476 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009477 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009478 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9479 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009480
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009481 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9482 backend private_monitoring
9483 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009484 stats uri /admin?stats
9485 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009486
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009487 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009488
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009489
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009490stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9491 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9492 Access control for statistics
9493
9494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9495 no | no | yes | yes
9496
9497 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9498 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9499 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9500 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9501 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9502 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9503
9504 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9505 instance.
9506
9507 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9508 about ACL usage.
9509
9510
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009511stats realm <realm>
9512 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009515 Arguments :
9516 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9517 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9518 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9519
9520 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9521 using a backslash ('\').
9522
9523 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9524 only related to authentication.
9525
9526 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9527 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9528 unobvious parameters.
9529
9530 Example :
9531 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9532 backend public_www
9533 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9534 stats enable
9535 stats hide-version
9536 stats scope .
9537 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009538 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009539 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9540 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9541
9542 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9543 backend private_monitoring
9544 stats enable
9545 stats uri /admin?stats
9546 stats refresh 5s
9547
9548 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9549
9550
9551stats refresh <delay>
9552 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009554 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009555 Arguments :
9556 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9557 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9558 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9559 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9560 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9561 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9562
9563 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9564 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9565 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9566 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9567
9568 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9569 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9570 unobvious parameters.
9571
9572 Example :
9573 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9574 backend public_www
9575 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9576 stats enable
9577 stats hide-version
9578 stats scope .
9579 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009580 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009581 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9582 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9583
9584 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9585 backend private_monitoring
9586 stats enable
9587 stats uri /admin?stats
9588 stats refresh 5s
9589
9590 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9591
9592
9593stats scope { <name> | "." }
9594 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009596 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009597 Arguments :
9598 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9599 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9600 section in which the statement appears.
9601
9602 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9603 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9604 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9605 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9606 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9607 exists.
9608
9609 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9610 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9611 unobvious parameters.
9612
9613 Example :
9614 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9615 backend public_www
9616 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9617 stats enable
9618 stats hide-version
9619 stats scope .
9620 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009622 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9623 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9624
9625 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9626 backend private_monitoring
9627 stats enable
9628 stats uri /admin?stats
9629 stats refresh 5s
9630
9631 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9632
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009633
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009634stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009635 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009637 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009638
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009639 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009640 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9641
9642 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9643 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9644
9645 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9646 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009647 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009648
9649 Example :
9650 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9651 backend private_monitoring
9652 stats enable
9653 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9654 stats uri /admin?stats
9655 stats refresh 5s
9656
9657 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9658 global section.
9659
9660
9661stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009662 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9664 yes | yes | yes | yes
9665 Arguments : none
9666
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009667 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009668 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9669 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9670 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9671 - IP (socket, server)
9672 - cookie (backend, server)
9673
9674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009676 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009677
9678 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9679
9680
9681stats show-node [ <name> ]
9682 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009684 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009685 Arguments:
9686 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9687 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9688
9689 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9690 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009691 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009692
9693 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9694 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9695 unobvious parameters.
9696
9697 Example:
9698 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9699 backend private_monitoring
9700 stats enable
9701 stats show-node Europe-1
9702 stats uri /admin?stats
9703 stats refresh 5s
9704
9705 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9706 section.
9707
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009708
9709stats uri <prefix>
9710 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009712 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009713 Arguments :
9714 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9715 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9716 query string.
9717
9718 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9719 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9720 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9721 possible to reach it in the application.
9722
9723 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009724 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009725 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9726 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9727 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9728 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9729
9730 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9731 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9732 an address or a port to statistics only.
9733
9734 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9735 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9736 unobvious parameters.
9737
9738 Example :
9739 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9740 backend public_www
9741 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9742 stats enable
9743 stats hide-version
9744 stats scope .
9745 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009747 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9748 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9749
9750 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9751 backend private_monitoring
9752 stats enable
9753 stats uri /admin?stats
9754 stats refresh 5s
9755
9756 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9757
9758
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009759stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9760 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009762 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009763
9764 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009765 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009766 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009767 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009768 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9769
9770 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9771 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9772 the "stick-table" statement.
9773
9774 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9775 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9776 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9777 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9778 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9779
9780 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9781 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9782 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9783 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9784 transformation rules.
9785
9786 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9787 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9788 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9789 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9790 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9791 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9792 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9793
9794 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9795 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9796 ACL based conditions.
9797
9798 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9799 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9800 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9801 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9802
9803 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9804 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9805 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9806 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9807
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009808 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9809 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009810 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009811
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009812 Example :
9813 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9814 # last 30 minutes
9815 backend pop
9816 mode tcp
9817 balance roundrobin
9818 stick store-request src
9819 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9820 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9821 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9822
9823 backend smtp
9824 mode tcp
9825 balance roundrobin
9826 stick match src table pop
9827 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9828 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9829
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009830 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009831 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009832
9833
9834stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9835 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9837 no | no | yes | yes
9838
9839 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9840 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9841 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9842 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9843
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009844 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9845 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009846 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009847
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009848 Examples :
9849 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009850 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009851
9852 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9853 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9854 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9855
9856
9857 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9858 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9859 backend http
9860 mode http
9861 balance roundrobin
9862 stick on src table https
9863 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9864 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9865 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9866
9867 backend https
9868 mode tcp
9869 balance roundrobin
9870 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9871 stick on src
9872 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9873 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9874
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009875 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009876
9877
9878stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9879 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9881 no | no | yes | yes
9882
9883 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009884 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009885 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009886 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009887 server is selected.
9888
9889 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9890 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9891 the "stick-table" statement.
9892
9893 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9894 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9895 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9896 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9897 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9898 address.
9899
9900 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9901 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9902 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9903 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9904 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9905 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9906 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9907 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9908 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9909 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9910
9911 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9912 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9913 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9914 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9915 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9916 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9917 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9918
9919 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9920 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9921 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9922 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9923
9924 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9925 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9926 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9927 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9928 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9929 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009930 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9931 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9932 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9933 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9934 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9935 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009936
9937 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9938 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9939 the request.
9940
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009941 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9942 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009943 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009944
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009945 Example :
9946 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9947 # last 30 minutes
9948 backend pop
9949 mode tcp
9950 balance roundrobin
9951 stick store-request src
9952 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9953 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9954 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9955
9956 backend smtp
9957 mode tcp
9958 balance roundrobin
9959 stick match src table pop
9960 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9961 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9962
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009963 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009964 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009965
9966
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009967stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009968 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9969 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009970 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009972 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009973
9974 Arguments :
9975 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9976 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9977 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9978 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9979
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009980 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9981 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9982 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9983 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9984
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009985 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9986 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9987 instance.
9988
9989 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9990 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9991 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9992 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9993 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9994 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009995 to 32 characters.
9996
9997 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9998 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9999 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010000 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010001 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10002 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010003
10004 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010005 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10006 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010007 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10008 increase.
10009
10010 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010011 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10012 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10013 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010014
10015 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10016 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10017 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10018 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010019 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010020 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10021 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10022 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10023 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10024 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10025 parameter (see below).
10026
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010027 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10028 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10029 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10030 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10031 soft restart.
10032
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010033 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10034 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010035
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010036 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10037 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10038 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10039 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010040 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010041 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010042 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10043 if not expiration delay is specified.
10044
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010045 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10046 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10047 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10048 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010049 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10050 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10051 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10052 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10053 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10054 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10055 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10056 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10057 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10058 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10059 types and their arguments.
10060
10061 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10062 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10063 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10064 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10065
10066 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10067 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10068 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010069 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010070
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010071 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10072 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10073 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010074 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010075 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010076 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010077
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010078 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10079 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10080 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10081 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10082
10083 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10084 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10085 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10086 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10087 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10088 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10089
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010090 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10091 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10092 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10093 they were received.
10094
10095 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10096 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10097 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10098 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10099 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10100
10101 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10102 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10103 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10104 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10105 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10106
10107 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10108 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10109 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10110
10111 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10112 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10113 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10114 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10115 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10116
10117 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10118 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10119 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10120 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10121 the client side.
10122
10123 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10124 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10125 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10126 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10127 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10128 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10129 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10130
10131 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10132 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10133 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10134 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10135 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10136 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010137 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010138
10139 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10140 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10141 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10142 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10143 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10144 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10145
10146 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010147 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010148 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10149 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10150
10151 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10152 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10153 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10154 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10155 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10156 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10157 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10158 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10159 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10160 recommended for better fairness.
10161
10162 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010163 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010164 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10165 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10166
10167 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10168 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10169 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10170 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10171 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10172 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10173 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10174 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10175 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10176 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010177
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010178 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10179 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010180 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10181 reference it.
10182
10183 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10184 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010185 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10186 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10187 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010188
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010189 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10190 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10191 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10192 something that can be ignored.
10193
10194 Example:
10195 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10196 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10197 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10198 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10199
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010200 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010201 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010202
10203
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010204stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010205 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10207 no | no | yes | yes
10208
10209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010210 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010211 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010212 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010213 server is selected.
10214
10215 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10216 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10217 the "stick-table" statement.
10218
10219 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10220 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10221 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10222 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10223
10224 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10225 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10226 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10227 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10228 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10229 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010230 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010231 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10232 rules.
10233
10234 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10235 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10236 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10237 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10238 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10239 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10240 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10241
10242 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10243 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10244 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10245 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10246
10247 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10248 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10249 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10250 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10251 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10252 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010253 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10254 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10255 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10256 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10257 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10258 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10259 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10260 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10261 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010262
10263 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10264
10265 Example :
10266 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10267 backend https
10268 mode tcp
10269 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010270 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010271 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010272
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010273 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10274 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10275
10276 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10277 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10278 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10279
10280 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10281 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010282
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010283 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10284 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10285 # at offset 44.
10286
10287 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10288 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10289
10290 # Learn on response if server hello.
10291 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010292
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010293 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10294 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10295
10296 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10297 extraction.
10298
10299
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010300tcp-check comment <string>
10301 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10302 it fails.
10303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10304 yes | no | yes | yes
10305
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010306 Arguments :
10307 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10308 rule fails.
10309
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010310 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10311 user-friendly error reporting.
10312
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010313 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10314 "tcp-check expect".
10315
10316
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010317tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10318 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010319 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010320 Opens a new connection
10321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010322 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010323
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010324 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010325 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10326
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010327 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010328 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010329
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010330 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010331 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10332 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010333 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010334
10335 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010336
10337 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10338
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010339 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10340
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010341 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10342
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010343 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10344
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010345 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10346 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10347 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10348 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10349
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010350 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10351 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10352 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10353 haproxy -vv.
10354
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010355 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010357 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10358 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10359 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10360
10361 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10362 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10363 of the sequence.
10364
10365 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10366 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10367 do.
10368
10369 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10370 unset-var or comment rules.
10371
10372 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010373 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10374 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10375 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10376 option tcp-check
10377 tcp-check connect
10378 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10379 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10380 tcp-check send \r\n
10381 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10382 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10383 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10384 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10385 tcp-check send \r\n
10386 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10387 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10388
10389 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10390 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010391 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010392 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10393 tcp-check connect port 143
10394 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10395 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10396
10397 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10398
10399
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010400tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010401 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010402 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010403 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010404 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010406 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010407
10408 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010409 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10410
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010411 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10412 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10413 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10414 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10415 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10416 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10417 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10418 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10419 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10420 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10421
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010422 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010423 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10424 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010425 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10426 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10427 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10428
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010429 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10430 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10431 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010432 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10433 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10434 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10435 example 404 with disable-on-404
10436 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10437 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010438 By default "L7OK" is used.
10439
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010440 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10441 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010442 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10443 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10444 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10445 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10446 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10447 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010448
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010449 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010450 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010451 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10452 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10453 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10454 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010455 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10456
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010457 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10458 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10459 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10460 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10461
10462 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10463 informational message reported in logs if an error
10464 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10465 log-format string.
10466
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010467 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10468 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10469 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10470 followed by some converters.
10471
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010472 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10473 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10474 with the usual backslash ('\').
10475 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010476 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010477 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10478 used upper or lower case.
10479
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010480 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10481
10482 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10483 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10484 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10485 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10486 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10487 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10488 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10489 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10490
10491 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10492 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10493 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10494 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10495 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10496 expression.
10497
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010498 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10499 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10500 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10501 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10502 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10503 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10504
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010505 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10506 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10507 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10508 this exact hexadecimal string.
10509 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10510
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010511 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10512 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10513 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10514 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10515 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10516 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10517 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10518 size.
10519
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010520 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10521 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10522 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10523 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10524 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10525 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10526 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10527 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10528 in a binary string before matching the response's
10529 buffer.
10530
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010531 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10532 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10533 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10534 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10535 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10536 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10537 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10538 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10539 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10540 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10541 the null character.
10542
10543 Examples :
10544 # perform a POP check
10545 option tcp-check
10546 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10547
10548 # perform an IMAP check
10549 option tcp-check
10550 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10551
10552 # look for the redis master server
10553 option tcp-check
10554 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010555 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010556 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10557 tcp-check expect string role:master
10558 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10559 tcp-check expect string +OK
10560
10561
10562 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10563 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10564
10565
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010566tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10567tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10568 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10569 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010571 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010572
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010573 Arguments :
10574 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10575
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010576 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10577 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010578
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010579 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10580 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010581
10582 Examples :
10583 # look for the redis master server
10584 option tcp-check
10585 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10586 tcp-check expect string role:master
10587
10588 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10589 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10590
10591
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010592tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10593tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10594 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10595 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010598
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010599 Arguments :
10600 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010601
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010602 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10603 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010604
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010605 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10606 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10607 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010608
10609 Examples :
10610 # redis check in binary
10611 option tcp-check
10612 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10613 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10614
10615
10616 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10617 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10618
10619
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010620tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010621 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010623 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010624
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010625 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010626 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10627 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10628 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10629 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10630 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10631 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10632 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10633 and '-'.
10634
10635 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10636
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010637 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010638 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10639
10640
10641tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010642 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010644 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010645
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010646 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010647 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10648 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10651 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10652 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10653 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10654 and '-'.
10655
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010656 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010657 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10658
10659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010660tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10661 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10663 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010664 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010665 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10666 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010667
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010668 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010669
10670 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10671 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010672 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10673 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10674 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10675 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10676 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10677 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010678
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010679 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10680 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10681 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10682 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010683
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010684 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010685 - accept :
10686 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10687 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10688 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010690 - reject :
10691 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10692 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10693 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10694 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10695 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10696 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10697 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10698 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10699 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10700 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10701 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010702 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010703
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010704 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10705 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10706 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10707 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10708 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10709 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10710 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10711 hosts.
10712
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010713 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10714 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10715 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10716 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10717 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10718 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10719 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10720 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10721
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010722 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10723 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10724 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10725 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10726 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10727 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10728 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10729 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10730 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010731 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10732 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010733
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010734 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010735 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010736 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10737 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10738 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010739 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010740 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10741 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10742 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10743 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10744 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10745 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10746 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10747 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010748
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010749 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010750 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010751 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010752 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010753 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10754 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10755 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010756
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010757 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10758 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10759 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10760 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010761
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010762 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10763 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10764 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10765 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10766 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010767 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10768 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10769 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10770 layer7 information is extracted.
10771
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010772 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10773 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10774 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10775 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10776 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010777
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010778 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10779 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10780 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10781 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10782
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010783 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10784 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10785 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10786 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10787
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010788 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10789 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10790 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10791 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10792 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010793
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010794 - set-src <expr> :
10795 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10796 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10797 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010798 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010800 Arguments:
10801 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10802 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010803
10804 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010805 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10806
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010807 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10808 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010809
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010810 - set-src-port <expr> :
10811 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10812 expression.
10813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010814 Arguments:
10815 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10816 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010817
10818 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010819 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10820
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010821 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10822 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10823 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010824
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010825 - set-dst <expr> :
10826 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10827 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10828 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10829 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10830 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10831
10832 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10833 followed by some converters.
10834
10835 Example:
10836
10837 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10838 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10839
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010840 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10841 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10842
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010843 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10844 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10845 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10846 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10847
10848
10849 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10850 followed by some converters.
10851
10852 Example:
10853
10854 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10855
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010856 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10857 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10858 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10859
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010860 - "silent-drop" :
10861 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010863 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10864 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10865 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10866 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10867 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010868 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10869 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010870 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10871 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010872 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010873 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10874 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10875 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10876 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10877
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010878 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10879 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10880 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010882 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10883 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10884 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010886 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010887 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010888 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010889
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010890 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10891 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10892 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010893
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010894 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010895 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10896 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010897
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010898 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10899
10900 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10901
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010902 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10903
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010904 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010905
10906
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010907tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10908 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010910 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010911 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010912 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10913 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010914
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010915 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010916
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010917 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010918 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10919 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10920 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10921 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010923 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10924 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10925 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10926 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010927 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10928 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10929 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10930 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10931 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10932 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010933 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010934 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010936 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10937 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10938 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10939 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010940
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010941 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010942 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010943 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010944 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10945 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010946 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010947 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010948 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010949 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010950 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010951 - set-dst <expr>
10952 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010953 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010954 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010955 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010957 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010958
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010959 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10960 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010961 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10962 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010963
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010964 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10965 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10966 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10967 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10968 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10969 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010971 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010972 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10973 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010975 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010976 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10977 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10978 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10979 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010980 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10981 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10982 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010983
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010984 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010985 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10986 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10987 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010988
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010989 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10990 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10991
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010992 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010993 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10994 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010995
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010996 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10997 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010998 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010999 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11000 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011001 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011002 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011003 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011004 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11005 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011007 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11008 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011009
11010 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11011 followed by some converters.
11012
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011013 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11014 <var-name>.
11015
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011016 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11017 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11018 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11019 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11020 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11021
11022 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11023 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11024 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11025 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11026 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11027 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11028 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11029 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11030 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11031 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11032 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11033
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011034 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11035 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11036 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11037 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11038 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11039
11040 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11041
11042 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11043
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011044 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11045 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11046 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11047 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11048 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11049 evaluated.
11050
11051 Example:
11052 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11053
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011054 Example:
11055
11056 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011057 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011058
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011059 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011060 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11061 # and reject everything else.
11062 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11063 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011064 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011065 tcp-request content reject
11066
11067 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011068 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11069 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11070 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011071 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011072
11073 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11074 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11075 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011076 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011077 tcp-request content reject
11078
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011079 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011080 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011081 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011082 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011083 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11084 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011085
11086 Example:
11087 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11088 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011089 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011091 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011092 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011093
11094 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011095 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011096 # protecting all our sites
11097 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011098 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11099 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011100 ...
11101 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11102
11103 backend http_dynamic
11104 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011105 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011106 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011107 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011108 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011109 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011110 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011113
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011114 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11115 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011116
11117
11118tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11119 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011121 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011122 Arguments :
11123 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11124 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11125 as explained at the top of this document.
11126
11127 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11128 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11129 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11130 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11131 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11132
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011133 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11134 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11135 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11136 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11137
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011138 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11139 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011140 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011141 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011142 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11143 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11144 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11145 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011146
11147 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11148 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11149 it pass through unaffected.
11150
11151 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11152 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11153 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011154 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011155 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11156 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011157 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11158 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11159 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011160
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011161 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011162 "timeout client".
11163
11164
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011165tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11166 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11168 no | no | yes | yes
11169 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011170 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11171 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011172
11173 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011175 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011176 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11177 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011178 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11179 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011180
11181 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11182
11183 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11184 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11185 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11186 inserted.
11187
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011188 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011189 - accept :
11190 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11191 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11192 the rules evaluation.
11193
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011194 - close :
11195 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11196 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11197 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11198 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11199 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11200 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011201 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011202 protocols.
11203
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011204 - reject :
11205 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11206 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011207 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011208
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011209 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11210 Sets a variable.
11211
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011212 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11213 Unsets a variable.
11214
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011215 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11216 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11217 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11218 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11219
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011220 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11221 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11222 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11223 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11224
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011225 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11226 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11227 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11228 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11229 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011230
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011231 - "silent-drop" :
11232 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011233 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011234 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11235 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11236 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11237 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11238 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011239 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11240 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011241 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11242 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011243 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011244 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11245 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11246 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11247 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11248
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011249 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11250 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11251
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011252 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11253 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11254 for changing the default action to a reject.
11255
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011256 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11257 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11258 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11259 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011260 period.
11261
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011262 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11263 declared inline.
11264
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011265 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11266 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011267 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011268 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11269 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011270 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011272 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011273 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11274 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011276 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11277 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011278
11279 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11280 followed by some converters.
11281
11282 Example:
11283
11284 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11285
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011286 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11287 <var-name>.
11288
11289 Example:
11290
11291 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11292
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011293 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11294 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11295 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11296 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11297 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11298
11299 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11300
11301 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11302
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011303 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11304
11305 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11306
11307
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011308tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11309 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11311 no | yes | yes | no
11312 Arguments :
11313 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11314 below.
11315
11316 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11317
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011318 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011319 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11320 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11321 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11322 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11323 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11324 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11325 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011326 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011327 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11328 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11329 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11330 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11331 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11332 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11333 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11334 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11335 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11336 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11337 instead.
11338
11339 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11340 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11341 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11342 rules which may be inserted.
11343
11344 Several types of actions are supported :
11345 - accept : the request is accepted
11346 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11347 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11348 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011349 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011350 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011351 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011352 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011353 - silent-drop
11354
11355 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11356 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11357 sections for a complete description.
11358
11359 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11360 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11361 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11362
11363 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11364 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11365 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11366 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11367 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11368
11369 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11370 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11371
11372 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11373 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11374 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11375
11376 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11377 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11378 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11379
11380 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11381 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11382 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11383
11384 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11385 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11386 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11387
11388 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11389
11390 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11391
11392
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011393tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11394 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11396 no | no | yes | yes
11397 Arguments :
11398 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11399 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11400 as explained at the top of this document.
11401
11402 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11403
11404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011405timeout check <timeout>
11406 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11407 established.
11408
11409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11410 yes | no | yes | yes
11411 Arguments:
11412 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11413 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11414 as explained at the top of this document.
11415
11416 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11417 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011418 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011419 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011420 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11421 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11422 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011423
11424 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11425 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11426
11427 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11428 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011429 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011430
11431 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11432 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11433 forget about it.
11434
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011435 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11436 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011437
11438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011439timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011440 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11442 yes | yes | yes | no
11443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011444 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011445 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11446 as explained at the top of this document.
11447
11448 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11449 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11450 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011451 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11452 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11453 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11454 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011455 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11456 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11457 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011458 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011459 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011460 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11461 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011462 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11463 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011464
11465 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11466 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11467 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11468 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011469 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011470 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11471
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011472 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011473
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011474 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011476
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011477timeout client-fin <timeout>
11478 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11480 yes | yes | yes | no
11481 Arguments :
11482 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11483 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11484 as explained at the top of this document.
11485
11486 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11487 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11488 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11489 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11490 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11491 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11492 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011493 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11494 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11495 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011496
11497 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11498 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11499 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11500
11501 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11502
11503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011504timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011505 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11507 yes | no | yes | yes
11508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011509 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11511 as explained at the top of this document.
11512
11513 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011514 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011515 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011516 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011517 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11518 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011519
11520 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11521 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11522 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11523 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011524 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011525 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11526
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011527 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011529
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011530timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11531 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11533 yes | yes | yes | yes
11534 Arguments :
11535 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11536 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11537 as explained at the top of this document.
11538
11539 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11540 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11541 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11542 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11543 once the request has started to present itself.
11544
11545 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11546 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11547 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11548 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11549 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11550
11551 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11552 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11553 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11554 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11555
11556 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11557 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011559 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11560 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011561 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011562
11563 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11564 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11565 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11566 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11567
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011568 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11569 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011570 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11571
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011572 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11573
11574
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011575timeout http-request <timeout>
11576 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011578 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011579 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011580 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011581 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11582 as explained at the top of this document.
11583
11584 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11585 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11586 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11587 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11588 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11589 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11590 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011591 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11592 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11593 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11594 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011595 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011596 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11597 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011598
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011599 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11600 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11601 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11602 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11603 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011604 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011605
11606 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11607 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011608 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011609 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11610 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11611
11612 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011613 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11614 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11615 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011616
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011617 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011618 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011619
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011620
11621timeout queue <timeout>
11622 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11624 yes | no | yes | yes
11625 Arguments :
11626 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11627 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11628 as explained at the top of this document.
11629
11630 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11631 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11632 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11633 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11634 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11635
11636 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11637 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11638 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11639 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11640
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011641 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011642
11643
11644timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011645 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11647 yes | no | yes | yes
11648 Arguments :
11649 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11650 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11651 as explained at the top of this document.
11652
11653 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11654 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11655 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11656 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11657 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11658 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11659 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11660
11661 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11662 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11663 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11664 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11665 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011666 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011667 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011668 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11669 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011670 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11671 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011672
11673 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11674 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11675 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11676 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011677 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011678 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11679
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011680 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011681
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011682
11683timeout server-fin <timeout>
11684 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11686 yes | no | yes | yes
11687 Arguments :
11688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11690 as explained at the top of this document.
11691
11692 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11693 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11694 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11695 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11696 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11697 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11698 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11699 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11700 situations, it should not be needed.
11701
11702 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11703 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11704 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11705
11706 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11707
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011708
11709timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011710 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11712 yes | yes | yes | yes
11713 Arguments :
11714 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11715 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11716 as explained at the top of this document.
11717
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011718 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11719 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11720 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011721
11722 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11723 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11724 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11725 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011726 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011727
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011728 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011729
11730
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011731timeout tunnel <timeout>
11732 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11734 yes | no | yes | yes
11735 Arguments :
11736 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11737 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11738 as explained at the top of this document.
11739
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011740 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011741 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11742 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11743 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011744 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11745 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011746 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11747 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11748 specified.
11749
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011750 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11751 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11752 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11753 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11754 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11755 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11756 state.
11757
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011758 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11759 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11760 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11761 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011762 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011763
11764 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11765 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11766 forget about it.
11767
11768 Example :
11769 defaults http
11770 option http-server-close
11771 timeout connect 5s
11772 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011773 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011774 timeout server 30s
11775 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11776
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011777 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011778
11779
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011780transparent (deprecated)
11781 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011783 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011784 Arguments : none
11785
11786 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11787 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11788 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11789 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11790 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11791 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11792 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11793 appropriate server.
11794
11795 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11796
11797 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11798 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11799
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011800 See also: "option transparent"
11801
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011802unique-id-format <string>
11803 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11805 yes | yes | yes | no
11806 Arguments :
11807 <string> is a log-format string.
11808
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011809 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11810 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11811 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11812 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011813
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011814 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11815 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11816 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11817 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11818 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11819 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11820 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11821 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011822
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011823 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11824 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011825
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011826 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011827
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011828 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011829
11830 will generate:
11831
11832 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11833
11834 See also: "unique-id-header"
11835
11836unique-id-header <name>
11837 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11839 yes | yes | yes | no
11840 Arguments :
11841 <name> is the name of the header.
11842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011843 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11844 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011846 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011847
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011848 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011849 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11850
11851 will generate:
11852
11853 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11854
11855 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011856
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011857use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011858 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11860 no | yes | yes | no
11861 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011862 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11863 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011864
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011865 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11866 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011867
11868 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11869 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11870 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011871 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011872 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011873 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11874 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011875
11876 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11877 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11878 assign the backend.
11879
11880 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11881 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11882 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11883 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11884 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11885 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11886
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011887 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011888 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011889 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11890 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11891 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11892
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011893 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11894 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11895 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11896 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11897 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11898 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11899 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11900 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11901 cannot be forced from the request.
11902
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011903 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011904 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11905 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11906
11907 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11908 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011909
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011910use-fcgi-app <name>
11911 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11913 no | no | yes | yes
11914 Arguments :
11915 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11916
11917 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011918
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011919use-server <server> if <condition>
11920use-server <server> unless <condition>
11921 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11923 no | no | yes | yes
11924 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011925 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11926 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011927
11928 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11929
11930 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11931 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11932 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11933
11934 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11935 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11936 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11937 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11938 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11939 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11940 matches will assign the server.
11941
11942 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11943 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11944 with the next rules until one matches.
11945
11946 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11947 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11948 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11949 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11950
11951 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11952 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11953 stripped.
11954
11955 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11956 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11957 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11958 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11959
11960 Example :
11961 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11962 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11963 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11964 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11965 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11966 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011967 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011968 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11969 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11970
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011971 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11972 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11973 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11974 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11975 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11976 and we fall back to load balancing.
11977
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011978 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011979
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100119815. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011982--------------------------
11983
11984The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11985depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11986settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11987written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11988described in this section.
11989
11990
119915.1. Bind options
11992-----------------
11993
11994The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11995as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11996no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11997parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11998while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11999provided immediately after the setting name.
12000
12001The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12002
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012003accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12004 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12005 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12006 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12007 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12008 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12009 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12010 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12011 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12012 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012013 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12014 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12015 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012017accept-proxy
12018 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012019 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12020 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012021 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12022 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12023 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12024 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012025 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012026 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12027 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012028 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12029 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012030
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012031allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012032 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012033 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012034 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012035 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12036 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012037
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012038alpn <protocols>
12039 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12040 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12041 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012042 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012043 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012044 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12045 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12046 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12047 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12048 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12049 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12050 preference, like below :
12051
12052 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012053
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012054backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012055 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012056 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12057
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012058curves <curves>
12059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12060 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12061 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12062 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12063 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12064 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12065
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012066ecdhe <named curve>
12067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012068 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12069 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012070
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012071ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012072 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12073 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12074 client's certificate.
12075
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012076ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12078 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12079 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12080 error is ignored.
12081
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012082ca-sign-file <cafile>
12083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12084 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12085 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12086 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12087 'generate-certificates' for details.
12088
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012089ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12091 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12092 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12093 'generate-certificates' for details.
12094
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012095ca-verify-file <cafile>
12096 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12097 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12098 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12099 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12100 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12101
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012102ciphers <ciphers>
12103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12104 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012105 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012106 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012107 information and recommendations see e.g.
12108 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12109 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12110 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12111
12112ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12114 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12115 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12116 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012117 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12118 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012119
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012120crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12122 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12123 to verify client's certificate.
12124
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012125crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12127 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12128 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12129 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12130 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012131 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12132 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012133
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012134 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12135 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12136
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012137 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12138 are loaded.
12139
12140 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012141 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12142 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12143 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12144 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12145 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12146 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12147 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012148 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012149
12150 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12151 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12152 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12153 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012154 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12155 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012156
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012157 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012158
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012159 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012160 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012161 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12162 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012163 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12164 clients).
12165
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012166 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12167 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12168 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12169 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12170 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12171 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12172 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12173 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12174 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12175 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12176 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12177 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12178 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12179
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012180 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12181 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12182 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12183 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12184 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12185
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012186 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12187 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12188 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12189 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012190
12191 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12192 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12193 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12194 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12195 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12196 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12197 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12198 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12199 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12200
12201 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12202
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012203 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012204 a cert bundle.
12205
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012206 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012207 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12208 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12209 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12210 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12211 provide multi-cert support.
12212
12213 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12214
12215 Filename | CN | SAN
12216 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12217 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012218 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012219 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12220 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12221
12222 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12223 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12224 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12225 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012226 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12227 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12228 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012229
12230 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12231 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12232
12233 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12234 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12235 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12236
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012237crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012239 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012240 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012241 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012242
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012243crt-list <file>
12244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012245 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12246 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012247
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012248 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12249
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012250 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12251 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
12252 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
12253 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012254
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012255 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12256 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12257 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12258 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12259 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12260 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12261 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12262 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012263
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012264 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012265 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012266 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12267 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12268 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012269
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012270 crt-list file example:
12271 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012272 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012273 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012274 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012275
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012276defer-accept
12277 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12278 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12279 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012280 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012281 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12282 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12283 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12284 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12285 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12286 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12287 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12288
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012289expose-fd listeners
12290 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12291 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012292 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12293 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012294 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012295
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012296force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012297 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012298 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012299 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012300 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012301
12302force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012303 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012304 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012305 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012306
12307force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012308 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012309 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012310 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012311
12312force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012313 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012314 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012315 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012316
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012317force-tlsv13
12318 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12319 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012320 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012321
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012322generate-certificates
12323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12324 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12325 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12326 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12327 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12328 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12329 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12330 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12331 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12332 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12333 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12334
12335 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12336 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012337 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012338 certificate is used many times.
12339
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012340gid <gid>
12341 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12342 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12343 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12344 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12345 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12346
12347group <group>
12348 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12349 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12350 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12351 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12352 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12353
12354id <id>
12355 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12356 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12357 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12358 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12359
12360interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012361 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12362 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12363 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12364 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12365 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12366 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012367 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12368 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12369 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12370 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12371 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12372 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012373
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012374level <level>
12375 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12376 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12377 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012378 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012379 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12380 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12381 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012382 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012383 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012384 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012385 all counters).
12386
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012387severity-output <format>
12388 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12389 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12390 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12391 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12392 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12393 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12394 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12395 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12396 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12397 rfc5424 convention.
12398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012399maxconn <maxconn>
12400 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12401 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12402 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12403 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12404 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12405 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12406 eat all memory.
12407
12408mode <mode>
12409 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12410 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12411 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12412 UNIX sockets.
12413
12414mss <maxseg>
12415 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12416 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12417 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12418 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12419 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12420 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12421 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12422 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12423 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12424 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12425 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12426
12427name <name>
12428 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12429 page.
12430
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012431namespace <name>
12432 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12433 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12434 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12435 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12436
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012437nice <nice>
12438 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12439 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12440 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12441 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12442 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12443 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12444 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12445 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12446 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12447 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12448 one for an RDP socket.
12449
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012450no-ca-names
12451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12452 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012453 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012454
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012455no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012457 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012458 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012459 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012460 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12461 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012462
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012463no-tls-tickets
12464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12465 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12466 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012467 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12468 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012469 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12470 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12471 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012472
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012473no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012475 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012476 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012477 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012478 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12479 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012480
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012481no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012483 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012484 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012485 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012486 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12487 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012488
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012489no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012491 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012492 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012493 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012494 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12495 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012496
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012497no-tlsv13
12498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12499 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12500 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12501 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012502 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12503 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012504
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012505npn <protocols>
12506 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12507 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12508 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012509 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012510 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012511 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12512 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12513 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12514 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12515 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012516
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012517prefer-client-ciphers
12518 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12519 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12520 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012521 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12522 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12523 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012524
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012525process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012526 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012527 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012528 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012529 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12530 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12531 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12532 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012533 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012534 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12535 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12536 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12537 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12538 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012539
12540 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12541
12542 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12543 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12544 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12545 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12546 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12547 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12548 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12549 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012550
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012551proto <name>
12552 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12553 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12554 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12555 in haproxy -vv.
12556 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12557 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012558 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012559 h2" on the bind line.
12560
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012561ssl
12562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012563 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012564 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12565 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012566 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12567 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012568
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012569ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12570 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012571 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12572 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12573 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012574 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12575
12576ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012577 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12578 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12579 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12580 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012581
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012582strict-sni
12583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12584 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12585 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12586 See the "crt" option for more information.
12587
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012588tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012589 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012590 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12591 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012592 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012593 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12594 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12595 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12596 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12597 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12598 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12599 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12600
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012601tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012602 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012603 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12604 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12605 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12606 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12607 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12608 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12609 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012610 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12611 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12612 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012613
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012614tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12615 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012616 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12617 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12618 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12619 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12620 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12621 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12622 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12623 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12624 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12625 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012626 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12627 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012629transparent
12630 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12631 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12632 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12633 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12634 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12635 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12636 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12637 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12638 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12639 so check for support with your vendor.
12640
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012641v4v6
12642 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12643 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12644 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12645 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012646 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012647
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012648v6only
12649 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12650 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12651 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012652 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12653 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012654
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012655uid <uid>
12656 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12657 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12658 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12659 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12660 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12661
12662user <user>
12663 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12664 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12665 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12666 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12667 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12668
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012669verify [none|optional|required]
12670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12671 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12672 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12673 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12674 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012675 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12676 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12677 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12678 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012679
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200126805.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012681------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012683The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12684which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12685arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12686settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12687after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12688Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12689address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012691 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012692 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012693
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012694Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12695keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012697The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012698
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012699addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012700 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012701 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12702 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12703 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12704 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12705 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012706
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012707agent-check
12708 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012709 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012710 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12711 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12712 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012713
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012714 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012715 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012716 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12717 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12718 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012720 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12721 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12722 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12723 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12724 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012725
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012726 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012727 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012728
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012729 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12730 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12731 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012733 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12734 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12735 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012736
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012737 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12738 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12739 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12740 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12741 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012742 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012743 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012744
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012745 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12746 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012747
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012748 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12749 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12750 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12751 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12752 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12753 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12754 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12755 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12756 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012757
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012758 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12759 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012760 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12761 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12762 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012763 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012764
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012765 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012766 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012767
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012768agent-send <string>
12769 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12770 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12771 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12772 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12773 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12774
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012775agent-inter <delay>
12776 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12777 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12778
12779 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12780 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12781 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12782 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12783 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12784 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12785 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12786 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12787 of backends use the same servers.
12788
12789 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12790
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012791agent-addr <addr>
12792 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12793
12794 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12795 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12796 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12797 hostname, it will be resolved.
12798
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012799agent-port <port>
12800 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12801
12802 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12803
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012804allow-0rtt
12805 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012806 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12807 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012808
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012809alpn <protocols>
12810 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12811 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12812 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012813 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012814 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12815 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12816 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12817 now obsolete NPN extension.
12818 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12819 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12820
12821 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012823backup
12824 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12825 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12826 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12827 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012828 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12829 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012830
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012831ca-file <cafile>
12832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12833 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12834 server's certificate.
12835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012836check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012837 This option enables health checks on a server:
12838 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12839 considered available.
12840 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12841 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12842 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12843 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12844 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12845 set.
12846 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12847 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12848 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12849 exchanges succeed.
12850
12851 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12852 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12853 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12854 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12855 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012856 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012857 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12858
12859 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12860 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12861
12862 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12863 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12864
12865 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12866 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12867 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12868 available.
12869
12870 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12871 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12872 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12873
12874 Example:
12875 # simple tcp check
12876 backend foo
12877 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12878 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12879 backend foo
12880 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12881 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12882 backend foo
12883 option tcp-check
12884 tcp-check connect
12885 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012886
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012887check-send-proxy
12888 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12889 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12890 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12891 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12892 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12893 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12894 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12895
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012896check-alpn <protocols>
12897 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12898 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12899 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12900
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012901check-proto <name>
12902 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12903 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12904 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12905 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12906 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12907 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12908 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12909
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012910check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012911 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012912 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12913 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012914
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012915check-ssl
12916 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12917 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12918 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12919 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012920 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012921 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12922 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012923 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012924 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12925 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012926
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012927check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012928 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012929 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12930 for normal traffic.
12931
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012932ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12934 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12935 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012936 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12937 information and recommendations see e.g.
12938 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12939 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12940 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012941
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012942ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12944 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12945 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12946 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012947 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12948 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12949 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012951cookie <value>
12952 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12953 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12954 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12955 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12956 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12957 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12958 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12959
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012960crl-file <crlfile>
12961 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12962 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12963 to verify server's certificate.
12964
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012965crt <cert>
12966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12967 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12968 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12969 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12970 certificate request.
12971
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012972disabled
12973 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12974 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12975 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12976 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12977 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012978 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012979
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012980enabled
12981 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12982 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12983 default value.
12984 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12985 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012987error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012988 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12989 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12990 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012992 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012994fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012995 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12996 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12997 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12998
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012999force-sslv3
13000 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13001 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013002 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013003 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013004
13005force-tlsv10
13006 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013007 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013008 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013009
13010force-tlsv11
13011 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013012 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013013 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013014
13015force-tlsv12
13016 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013017 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013018 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013019
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013020force-tlsv13
13021 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13022 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013023 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013025id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013026 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13027 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13028 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013029
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013030init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13031 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13032 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013033 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013034 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13035 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13036 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13037 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13038 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13039 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13040 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13041 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13042 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013043 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013044 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13045 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13046 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13047 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13048 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13049 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013050 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013051
13052 Example:
13053 defaults
13054 # never fail on address resolution
13055 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013057inter <delay>
13058fastinter <delay>
13059downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013060 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13061 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13062 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13063 between checks depending on the server state :
13064
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013065 Server state | Interval used
13066 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13067 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13068 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13069 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13070 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13071 or yet unchecked. |
13072 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13073 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13074 | "inter" otherwise.
13075 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013077 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13078 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13079 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13080 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013081 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13082 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13083 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13084 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13085 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013086
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013087log-proto <logproto>
13088 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13089 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13090 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13091 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013093maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013094 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13095 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013096 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13097 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013098 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13099 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13100 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13101 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13102
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013103 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13104 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13105 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13106 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13107 than 50 concurrent requests.
13108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013109maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013110 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13111 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13112 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13113 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13114 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13115 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13116 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13117
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013118max-reuse <count>
13119 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13120 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13121 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13122 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13123 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13124 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13125 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13126 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013128minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013129 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13130 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13131 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13132 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13133 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13134 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013135 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013136 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013137
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013138namespace <name>
13139 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13140 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13141 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13142 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13143
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013144no-agent-check
13145 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13146 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13147 default value.
13148 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13149 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13150
13151no-backup
13152 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13153 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13154 default value.
13155 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13156 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13157
13158no-check
13159 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13160 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13161 default value.
13162 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13163 "default-server" "check" setting.
13164
13165no-check-ssl
13166 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13167 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13168 default value.
13169 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13170 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13171
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013172no-send-proxy
13173 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13174 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13175 default value.
13176 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13177 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13178
13179no-send-proxy-v2
13180 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13181 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13182 default value.
13183 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13184 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13185
13186no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13187 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13188 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13189 default value.
13190 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13191 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13192
13193no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13194 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13195 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13196 default value.
13197 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13198 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13199
13200no-ssl
13201 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13202 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13203 default value.
13204 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13205 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13206
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013207no-ssl-reuse
13208 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13209 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13210 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13211 and for paranoid users.
13212
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013213no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013214 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13215 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013216 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013217
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013218 Supported in default-server: No
13219
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013220no-tls-tickets
13221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13222 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13223 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013224 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13225 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013226 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13227 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13228 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013229 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013230
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013231no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013232 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013233 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13234 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013235 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13236 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013237 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013238
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013239 Supported in default-server: No
13240
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013241no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013242 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013243 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13244 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013245 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13246 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013247 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013248
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013249 Supported in default-server: No
13250
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013251no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013252 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013253 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13254 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013255 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13256 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013257 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013258
13259 Supported in default-server: No
13260
13261no-tlsv13
13262 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13263 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13264 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13265 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13266 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013267 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013268
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013269 Supported in default-server: No
13270
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013271no-verifyhost
13272 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13273 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13274 default value.
13275 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13276 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013277
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013278no-tfo
13279 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13280 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13281 default value.
13282 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13283 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13284
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013285non-stick
13286 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13287 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13288 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13289
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013290npn <protocols>
13291 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13292 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13293 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013294 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013295 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13296 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13297 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013299observe <mode>
13300 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13301 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13302 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13303 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13304 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13305 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013306 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013307
13308 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013310on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013311 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13312 Currently, four modes are available:
13313 - fastinter: force fastinter
13314 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13315 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13316 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13317 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13318
13319 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13320
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013321on-marked-down <action>
13322 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13323 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013324 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13325 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13326 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13327 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13328 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13329 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13330 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13331 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013332
13333 Actions are disabled by default
13334
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013335on-marked-up <action>
13336 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13337 Currently one action is available:
13338 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13339 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13340 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13341 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013342 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13343 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013344 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13345 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13346
13347 Actions are disabled by default
13348
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013349pool-max-conn <max>
13350 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13351 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13352 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13353 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13354 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13355 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13356
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013357pool-purge-delay <delay>
13358 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013359 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013360 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013362port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013363 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13364 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13365 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13366 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13367 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13368 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13369
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013370proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013371 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13372 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13373 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13374 reported in haproxy -vv.
13375 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13376 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013378redir <prefix>
13379 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13380 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13381 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13382 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13383 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13384 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13385 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13386 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013387 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013388 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013389 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13390 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13391 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13392 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13393
13394 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013396rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013397 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13398 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13399 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13400
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013401resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13402 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13403 server.
13404
13405 Available options:
13406
13407 * allow-dup-ip
13408 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13409 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13410 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13411 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13412 For such case, simply enable this option.
13413 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13414
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013415 * ignore-weight
13416 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13417 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13418 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13419
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013420 * prevent-dup-ip
13421 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13422 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13423 same fqdn.
13424 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13425
13426 Example:
13427 backend b_myapp
13428 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13429 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13430 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13431
13432 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13433 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13434 it
13435 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13436 different address
13437
13438 Default value: not set
13439
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013440resolve-prefer <family>
13441 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13442 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13443 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13444 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13445
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013446 Default value: ipv6
13447
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013448 Example:
13449
13450 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013451
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013452resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013453 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013454 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013455 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013456 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13457 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013458 configured network, another address is selected.
13459
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013460 Example:
13461
13462 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013463
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013464resolvers <id>
13465 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13466 hostname.
13467
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013468 Example:
13469
13470 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013471
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013472 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013473
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013474send-proxy
13475 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13476 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13477 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13478 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013479 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13480 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13481 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13482 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13483 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13484 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13485 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13486 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13487 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13488 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013489 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13490 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013491
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013492send-proxy-v2
13493 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13494 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13495 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13496 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013497 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13498 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13499 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13500 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013501
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013502proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013503 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13504 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13505
13506 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13507 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13508 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13509 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13510 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13511 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13512 connection is supported).
13513 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13514 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13515 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13516 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13517 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13518 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13519 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013520
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013521send-proxy-v2-ssl
13522 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13523 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13524 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13525 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13526 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13527 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13528 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013529 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13530 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013531
13532send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13533 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13534 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13535 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13536 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13537 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13538 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13539 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13540 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013541 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13542 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013544slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013545 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13546 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13547 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13548 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13549 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13550 parameters :
13551
13552 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13553 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13554
13555 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13556 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13557 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13558 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13559
13560 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13561 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13562 seen as failed.
13563
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013564sni <expression>
13565 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13566 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13567 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13568 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013569 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13570 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013571 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013572 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13573 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013574
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013575source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013576source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013577source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013578 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13579 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13580 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13581 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13582
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013583 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13584 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13585 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13586 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13587 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13588 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13589 server.
13590
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013591 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13592 specifying the source address without port(s).
13593
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013594ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013595 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13596 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13597 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13598 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13599 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13600 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013601 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13602 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013603
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013604ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13605 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13606 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13607 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13608
13609ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13610 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13611 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13613
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013614ssl-reuse
13615 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13616 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13617 default value.
13618 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13619 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13620
13621stick
13622 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13623 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13624 default value.
13625 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13626 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013627
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013628socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013629 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013630 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13631 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13632
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013633tcp-ut <delay>
13634 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13635 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13636 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013638 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13639 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13640 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13641 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13642 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13643 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13644 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13645 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13646 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13647
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013648tfo
13649 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13650 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13651 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13652 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13653 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013654 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013656track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013657 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13658 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13659 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13660 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013661 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13662
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013663tls-tickets
13664 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13665 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13666 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013667 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13668 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13669 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013670 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013671 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013672
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013673verify [none|required]
13674 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013675 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013676 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13677 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013678 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013679 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13680 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13681 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13682 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13683 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13684 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13685 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13686 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013687
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013688verifyhost <hostname>
13689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013690 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13691 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13692 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13693 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13694 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13695 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13696 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13697 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013699weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013700 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13701 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13702 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013703 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13704 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13705 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13706 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13707 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13708 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013709
13710
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137115.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13712-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013713
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013714HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13715using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13716configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013717This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13718can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13719workload.
13720This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13721resolution at run time.
13722Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13723carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13724
13725
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137265.3.1. Global overview
13727----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013728
13729As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13730different steps of the process life:
13731
13732 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13733 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13734 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13735
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013736 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13737 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013738
13739A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13740 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13741 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13742 resolution to know this new IP.
13743
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013744When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013745HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013746SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13747from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13748will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13749will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013750
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013751A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013752 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013753 first valid response.
13754
13755 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13756 servers return an error.
13757
13758
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137595.3.2. The resolvers section
13760----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013761
13762This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013763HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13764contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013765
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013766When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13767uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13768is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13769answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13770
13771When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013772used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013773
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013774 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13775 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13776 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013777
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013778 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13779 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013780
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013781 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13782 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13783 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013784
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013785For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13786following scenarios are possible:
13787
13788 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13789 ignored
13790
13791 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13792 applied
13793
13794 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13795 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13796
13797 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13798 retries the query with a new type
13799
13800 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13801 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013802
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013803As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13804a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013805<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013806
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013807
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013808resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013809 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013810
13811A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13812
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013813accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013814 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013815 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013816 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13817 by RFC 6891)
13818
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013819 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13820
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013821nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13822 DNS server description:
13823 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13824 <ip> : IP address of the server
13825 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13826
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013827parse-resolv-conf
13828 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13829 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13830 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13831
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013832hold <status> <period>
13833 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13834 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013835 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013836 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013837 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13838 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13839 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13840
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013841 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013842
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013843resolve_retries <nb>
13844 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13845 giving up.
13846 Default value: 3
13847
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013848 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13849 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13850 type.
13851
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013852timeout <event> <time>
13853 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13854 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13855 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013856 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13857 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013858 Default value: 1s
13859 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013860 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013861 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013862 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13863 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13864
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013865 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013866
13867 resolvers mydns
13868 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13869 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013870 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013871 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013872 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013873 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013874 hold other 30s
13875 hold refused 30s
13876 hold nx 30s
13877 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013878 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013879 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013880
13881
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200138826. Cache
13883---------
13884
13885HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13886(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13887RAM.
13888
13889The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13890this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13891
13892If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13893independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13894when we try to allocate a new one.
13895
13896The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13897
13898It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13899"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13900for more details.
13901
13902When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13903replaced by "<CACHE>".
13904
13905
139066.1. Limitation
13907----------------
13908
13909The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13910
13911- If the response is not a 200
13912- If the response contains a Vary header
13913- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13914- If the response is not cacheable
13915
13916- If the request is not a GET
13917- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13918- If the request contains an Authorization header
13919
13920
139216.2. Setup
13922-----------
13923
13924To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13925the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13926
13927
139286.2.1. Cache section
13929---------------------
13930
13931cache <name>
13932 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13933 size of cache is mandatory.
13934
13935total-max-size <megabytes>
13936 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13937 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13938
13939max-object-size <bytes>
13940 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13941 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13942 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13943
13944max-age <seconds>
13945 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13946 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13947 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13948 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13949 default.
13950
13951
139526.2.2. Proxy section
13953---------------------
13954
13955http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13956 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13957 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13958 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13959 after this one.
13960
13961http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13962 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13963 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13964 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13965 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13966
13967
13968Example:
13969
13970 backend bck1
13971 mode http
13972
13973 http-request cache-use foobar
13974 http-response cache-store foobar
13975 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13976
13977 cache foobar
13978 total-max-size 4
13979 max-age 240
13980
13981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200139827. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13983----------------------------------
13984
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013985HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13987The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13988these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13989but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13990data called patterns.
13991
13992
139937.1. ACL basics
13994---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013995
13996The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13997content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13998from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13999simple :
14000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014002 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014003 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14004 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014006The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14007adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014008
14009In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014012
14013This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14014Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14015and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014016an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14017conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14018as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14019are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014020
14021ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14022'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14023which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14024
14025There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14026performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14029specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14030this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014031methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14032ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014033
14034Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14035 - boolean
14036 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14037 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14038 - string
14039 - data block
14040
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014041Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14042converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14043would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14044The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14045which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14046
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014047Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14048keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14049fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14050which are summarized in the table below :
14051
14052 +---------------------+-----------------+
14053 | Sample or converter | Default |
14054 | output type | matching method |
14055 +---------------------+-----------------+
14056 | boolean | bool |
14057 +---------------------+-----------------+
14058 | integer | int |
14059 +---------------------+-----------------+
14060 | ip | ip |
14061 +---------------------+-----------------+
14062 | string | str |
14063 +---------------------+-----------------+
14064 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14065 +---------------------+-----------------+
14066
14067Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14068matching method, see below.
14069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14071 - boolean
14072 - integer or integer range
14073 - IP address / network
14074 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14075 - regular expression
14076 - hex block
14077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014078The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14079
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014080 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14081 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014083 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014084 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014085 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014086 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14089read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14090if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14091lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14092will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14093beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14094a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14095lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14096exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14097
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014098The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14099parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14100ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14101a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14102check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14103
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014104The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14105socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14106file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14109loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14110
14111 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14112
14113In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14114the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14115case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14116as well.
14117
14118The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14119sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14120do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14121methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14122is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014123obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14125default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14126that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14127string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14128
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014129The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14130By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14131string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14132resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14133server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014134waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014135flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14136function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014138There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14139sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14140be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014141
14142 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14143 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14145 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14146 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14147 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014148
14149 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14150 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014152
14153 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014154 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014155
14156 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014158
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014159 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014160 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14161
14162 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14163 binary or string samples.
14164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14166 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14169 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14170 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014172 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14173 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14176 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014178 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14179 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14182 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014183 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014185 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14186 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14187 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014188
14189For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14190request, it is possible to do :
14191
14192 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14193
14194In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14195buffer, one would use the following acl :
14196
14197 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14198
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014199On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14200possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14201
14202 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14205criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14206method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14207to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14208criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14209the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014212the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14213For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14216 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14217 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14218 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014219
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014220
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014221The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14222types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14223combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14224brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14225default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 +-------------------------------------------------+
14228 | Input sample type |
14229 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014230 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14232 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014234 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014236 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014238 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014240 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014241 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014242 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014244 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014245 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014246 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014248 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014249 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014250 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014251 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014252 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014254 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014255 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14256 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14257 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014258
14259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142607.1.1. Matching booleans
14261------------------------
14262
14263In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14264Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14265When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14266that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14267
14268Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14269return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14270"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14271
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142737.1.2. Matching integers
14274------------------------
14275
14276Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14277enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14278to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14279
14280Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14281matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14282lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014283
14284For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14285unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14286representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14287
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014288As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14289two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14290instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14291ranges and operators.
14292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014293For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014294operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14295Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14296of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014298Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014299
14300 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14301 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14302 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14303 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14304 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014306For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014307
14308 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14309
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014310This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14311
14312 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14313
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143157.1.3. Matching strings
14316-----------------------
14317
14318String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14319different forms :
14320
14321 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014322 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323
14324 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326
14327 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14328 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14329
14330 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14331 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14332
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014333 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14335 matches.
14336
14337 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14338 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14339 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014340
14341String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14342exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14343characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14344string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14345to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014346before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014347
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014348Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14349(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14350Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14351
14352Example:
14353 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14354 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14355
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143577.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14358---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014359
14360Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14361they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14362possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14363passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14364the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014365the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14366match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014367
14368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143697.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14370-------------------------------------
14371
14372It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14373not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14374a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14375to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14376digits may be used upper or lower case.
14377
14378Example :
14379 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14380 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14381
14382
143837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14384---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014385
14386IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14387netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14388within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014389host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014390difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14391at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14392does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14393parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014394
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014395The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14396abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14397
14398 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14399 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14400 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14401 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14402 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14403 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14404 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14405 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14406
14407Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14408192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14409
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014410IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14411Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14412trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14413IPv6 patterns.
14414
14415HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14416following situations :
14417 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14418 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14419 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14420 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14421 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14422 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14423 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14424 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14425 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14426 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428
144297.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14430----------------------------------
14431
14432Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14433combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14434
14435 - AND (implicit)
14436 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14437 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014441 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14444indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14447"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14448requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14449is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14450
14451 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014452 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14453 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14454 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014455
14456To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14457and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14458
14459 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14460 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14461 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14462 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014464 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014465 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14466 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14467 use_backend www if host_www
14468
14469It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14470expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14471be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14472the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14473
14474 The following rule :
14475
14476 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014477 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478
14479 Can also be written that way :
14480
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014481 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482
14483It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14484to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14485simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14486sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14487good use is the following :
14488
14489 With named ACLs :
14490
14491 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14492 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14493 monitor fail if site_dead
14494
14495 With anonymous ACLs :
14496
14497 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14498
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014499See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14500keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501
14502
145037.3. Fetching samples
14504---------------------
14505
14506Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14507against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14508sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14509ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14510of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14511available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14512
14513This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14514Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14515compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14516deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14517
14518The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14519matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14520method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14521indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14522
14523As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14524when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14525mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14526the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14527ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14528
14529Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14530multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14531when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014532incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14533are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14535all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14536
14537Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14538 - name
14539 - name(arg1)
14540 - name(arg1,arg2)
14541
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014542
145437.3.1. Converters
14544-----------------
14545
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014546Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14547of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14548is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14549was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014550has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014551unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14552
14553These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14554sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14555the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014556support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014557
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014558A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14559support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14560supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14561(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14562bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014565
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001456651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14567 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14568 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14569 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14570 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14571 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14572
14573 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014574 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14575 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014576 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14577 frontend http-in
14578 bind *:8081
14579 default_backend servers
14580 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14581 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14582
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014583add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014584 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014585 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014586 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14587 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014588 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014589 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14590 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14591 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14592 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014593 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014594 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014595
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014596aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14597 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14598 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14599 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14600 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14601 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14602 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14603
14604 Example:
14605 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14606 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014608and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014609 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014610 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014611 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14612 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014613 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014614 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14615 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14616 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14617 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014619 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014620
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014621b64dec
14622 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14623 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14624
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014625base64
14626 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014627 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014628 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14629
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014630bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014631 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014632 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014633 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014634 presence of a flag).
14635
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014636bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14637 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14638 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014639 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014640
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014641concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14642 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14643 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14644 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14645 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14646 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14647 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14648 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14649 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14650 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14651 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014652 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14653 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14654 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14655 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014656
14657 Example:
14658 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14659 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14660 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014661 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014662 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14663
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014664cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014665 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14666 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014667
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014668crc32([<avalanche>])
14669 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14670 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14671 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14672 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14673 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14674 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14675 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14676 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14677 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14678 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014679 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14680
14681crc32c([<avalanche>])
14682 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14683 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14684 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14685 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14686 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14687 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14688 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14689 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014690
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014691cut_crlf
14692 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14693 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14694 updated.
14695
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014696da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014697 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14698 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14699 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14700 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014701 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014702 configuration language.
14703
14704 Example:
14705 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014706 bind *:8881
14707 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014708 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014709
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014710debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14711 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14712 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14713 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14714 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14715 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14716 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14717 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14718 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14719 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14720 printable sample types.
14721
14722 Example:
14723 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014724
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014725digest(<algorithm>)
14726 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14727 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14728
14729 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14730 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14731
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014732div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014733 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14734 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014735 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014736 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14737 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014738 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014739 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14740 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14741 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014744 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014745
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014746djb2([<avalanche>])
14747 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14748 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14749 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14750 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14751 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14752 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14753 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014754 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14755 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014756
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014757even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014758 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014759 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14760
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014761field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14762 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14763 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14764 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14765 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14766 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14767 fields.
14768
14769 Example :
14770 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14771 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14772 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14773 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14774 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014776hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014777 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014778 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014780 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014781
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014782hex2i
14783 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014784 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014785
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014786htonl
14787 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14788 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14789 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14790 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14791
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014792hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14793 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14794 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14795 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14796 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14797
14798 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14799 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14800
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014801http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014802 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14803 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014804 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14805 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14806 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14807 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14808 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14809 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14810 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14811 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014812
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014813in_table(<table>)
14814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14816 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014817 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014818 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14819
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014820ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14821 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014822 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014823 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14824 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14825 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14826 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14827 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014828
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014829json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014830 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014831 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014832 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014833 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14834 of errors:
14835 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14836 bytes, ...)
14837 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14838 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14839
14840 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14841 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14842 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14843 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14844 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14845 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014846 - "ascii" : never fails;
14847 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14848 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014849 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014850 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014851 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14852 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14853
14854 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014855 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014856
14857 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014858 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014859 capture request header user-agent len 150
14860 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014861
14862 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14863 GET / HTTP/1.0
14864 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14865
14866 Output log:
14867 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14868
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014869language(<value>[,<default>])
14870 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14871 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14872 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14873 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14874 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14875 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14876 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14877 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14878 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014879 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014880 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14881 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014882
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014883 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014884
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014885 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14886 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014888 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14889 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14890 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14891 use_backend spanish if es
14892 use_backend french if fr
14893 use_backend english if en
14894 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014895
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014896length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014897 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14898 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14899 type. The result is of type integer.
14900
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014901lower
14902 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14903 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14904 type. The result is of type string.
14905
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014906ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14907 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14908 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14909 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14910 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14911 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14912 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14913
14914 Example :
14915
14916 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014917 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014918 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14919
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014920ltrim(<chars>)
14921 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14922 representation of the input sample.
14923
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014924map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14925map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14926map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14927 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14928 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14929 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14930 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14931 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14932 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14933 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14934 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014935
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014936 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14937 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14938 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014939
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014940 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014941 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014942
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014943 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14944 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14945 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14946 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014947 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14948 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014949 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14950 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14951 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14952 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14953 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14954 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14955 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14956 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014957 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14958 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14959 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014960 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14961 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14962 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14963 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14964 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014965
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014966 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14967 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14968 the corresponding match text.
14969
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014970 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14971 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14972 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14973 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14974 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014975
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014976 Example :
14977
14978 # this is a comment and is ignored
14979 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14980 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14981 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14982 | | | `---------- value
14983 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14984 | `---------------------------- key
14985 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14986
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014987mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014988 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14989 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014990 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014991 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014992 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014993 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14994 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14995 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14996 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014997 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014998 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014999
15000mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015001 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015002 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15003 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015004 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015005 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15009 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15010 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015011 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015012 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015013
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015014nbsrv
15015 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15016 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15017 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15018 map lookup.
15019
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015020neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015021 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15022 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15023 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15024 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015025
15026not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015027 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015028 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015029 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015030 absence of a flag).
15031
15032odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015033 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015034 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15035
15036or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015037 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015038 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015039 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15040 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015041 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015042 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15043 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15044 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15045 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015046 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015047 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015048
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015049protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15050 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15051 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15052 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15053 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15054 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15055 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15056 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15057 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15058 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15059 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15060 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15061
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015062regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015063 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15064 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15065 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15066 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15067 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15068 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15069 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15070 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15071 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015072 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15073 of characters with other ones.
15074
15075 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15076 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15077 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15078 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15079 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15080 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015081
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015082 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015083
15084 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15085 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15086 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015087 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015088
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015089 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15090 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15091
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015092 # capture groups and backreferences
15093 # both lines do the same.
15094 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15095 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15096
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015097capture-req(<id>)
15098 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15099 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15100
15101 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015102 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15103 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015104
15105capture-res(<id>)
15106 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15107 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15108
15109 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015110 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15111 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015112
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015113rtrim(<chars>)
15114 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15115 of the input sample.
15116
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015117sdbm([<avalanche>])
15118 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15119 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15120 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15121 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15122 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15123 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15124 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015125 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15126 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015127
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015128set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015129 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15130 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15131 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015132 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015133 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15134 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015135 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015136 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15137 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015138 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015139 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015140
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015141sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015142 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015143 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15144
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015145sha2([<bits>])
15146 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15147 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15148
15149 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15150 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15151
15152 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15153 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15154
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015155srv_queue
15156 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15157 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15158 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15159 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15160 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15161
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015162strcmp(<var>)
15163 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15164 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15165 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15166 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15167 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15168 shorter).
15169
15170 Example :
15171
15172 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15173 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15174 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15175
15176
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015177sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015178 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15179 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015180 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015181 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15182 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015186 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015187 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15188 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015189 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015190 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015191
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015192table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15193 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15194 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15195 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15196 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15197 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15198 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15199
15200
15201table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15202 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15203 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15204 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15205 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15206 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15207 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15208
15209table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15210 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15211 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015212 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015213 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15214 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15215
15216table_conn_cur(<table>)
15217 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15218 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15219 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15220 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15221 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15222
15223table_conn_rate(<table>)
15224 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15225 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15226 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15227 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15228 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15229
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015230table_gpt0(<table>)
15231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15233 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15234 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15235 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15236
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015237table_gpc0(<table>)
15238 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15239 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15240 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15241 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15242 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15243
15244table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15245 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15246 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15247 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15248 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15249 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15250 sample fetch keyword.
15251
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015252table_gpc1(<table>)
15253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15255 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15256 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15257 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15258
15259table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15260 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15261 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15262 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15263 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15264 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15265 sample fetch keyword.
15266
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015267table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15268 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15269 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015270 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015271 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15272 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15273
15274table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15275 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15276 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15277 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15278 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15279 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15280 keyword.
15281
15282table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15283 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15284 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015285 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015286 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15287 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15288
15289table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15292 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15293 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15294 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15295 keyword.
15296
15297table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15298 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15299 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015300 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015301 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15302 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15303 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15304 keyword.
15305
15306table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15307 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15308 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015309 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015310 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15311 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15312 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15313 keyword.
15314
15315table_server_id(<table>)
15316 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15317 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15318 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15319 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15320 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15321 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15322
15323table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015326 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015327 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15328 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15329 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15330 keyword.
15331
15332table_sess_rate(<table>)
15333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15336 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15337 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15338 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15339 keyword.
15340
15341table_trackers(<table>)
15342 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15343 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15344 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15345 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15346 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15347 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15348 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15349 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15350 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15351 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15352
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015353upper
15354 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15355 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15356 type. The result is of type string.
15357
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015358url_dec([<in_form>])
15359 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15360 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15361 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15362 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15363 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15364 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015365
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015366ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015367 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015368 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15369 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15370 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015371 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15372 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15373 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15374 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015375 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015376 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15377 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015378
15379 Example:
15380 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15381 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15382
15383 message Point {
15384 int32 latitude = 1;
15385 int32 longitude = 2;
15386 }
15387
15388 message PPoint {
15389 Point point = 59;
15390 }
15391
15392 message Rectangle {
15393 // One corner of the rectangle.
15394 PPoint lo = 48;
15395 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15396 PPoint hi = 49;
15397 }
15398
15399 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15400 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15401 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15402
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015403 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15404 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015405 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015406 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15407
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015408 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015409
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015410 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015411
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015412 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015413 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15414 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15415
15416 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15417 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15418 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15419
15420 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15421 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15422 interpret the previous binary sample.
15423
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015424
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015425unset-var(<var name>)
15426 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15427 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15428 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15429 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15430 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15431 response),
15432 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15433 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15434 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15435 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15436
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015437utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15438 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15439 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15440 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15441 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15442 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15443 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15444
15445 Example :
15446
15447 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015448 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015449 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15450
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015451word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15452 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15453 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15454 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015455 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015456 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15457 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15458
15459 Example :
15460 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15461 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15462 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15463 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15464 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015465 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015466
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015467wt6([<avalanche>])
15468 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15469 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15470 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15471 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15472 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15473 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15474 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015475 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15476 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015477
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015478xor(<value>)
15479 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015480 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015481 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015482 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015483 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015484 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15485 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015486 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015487 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15488 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015490 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015491
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015492xxh32([<seed>])
15493 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15494 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15495 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15496 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15497 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15498 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15499 as cryptographically secure.
15500
15501xxh64([<seed>])
15502 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15503 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15504 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15505 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15506 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15507 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15508 as cryptographically secure.
15509
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015510
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155117.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512--------------------------------------------
15513
15514A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15515not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15516"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15517The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15518
15519always_false : boolean
15520 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15521 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15522
15523always_true : boolean
15524 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15525 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15526
15527avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015528 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15530 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15531 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15532 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15533 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15534 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15535 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15536 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15537 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15538 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15539 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15540 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15541 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015544 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15545 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15546 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15547 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015548 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15549
15550be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15551 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15552 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15553 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15554 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15555 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015556 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15557 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015558
15559 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15560 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15561 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15564 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15565 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15566 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015567 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15569 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015570
15571 Example :
15572 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15573 backend dynamic
15574 mode http
15575 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15576 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015577
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015578bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015579 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15580 of the string.
15581
15582bool(<bool>) : bool
15583 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15584 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015588 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15590 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015591
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015592 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015593 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015594 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15595
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015596 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15597 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015598
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015599 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015600 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015602 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015603 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015605 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015606
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015607 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15608 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015610 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015611
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015612cpu_calls : integer
15613 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15614 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15615 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15616 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15617 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15618 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15619
15620cpu_ns_avg : integer
15621 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15622 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15623 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15624 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15625 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15626 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15627 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15628 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15629 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15630 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15631 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15632
15633cpu_ns_tot : integer
15634 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15635 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15636 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15637 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15638 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15639 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15640 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15641 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15642 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15643 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15644 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15645 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15646 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15647
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015648date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015649 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015650
15651 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15652 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15653 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015654 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15655
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015656 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15657 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15658 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15659 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15660 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15661
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015662 Example :
15663
15664 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15665 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015666
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015667 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15668 # millisecond granularity
15669 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15670
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015671date_us : integer
15672 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15673 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15674 from the same timeval structure.
15675
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015676distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15677 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15678 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15679 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15680 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15681 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15682 list of supported tokens.
15683
15684distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15685 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15686 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15687 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15688 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15689 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15690 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15691 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15692 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15693 supported tokens.
15694
15695 Example :
15696 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15697 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15698 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15699 # send large files to the big farm
15700 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15701
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015702env(<name>) : string
15703 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15704 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15705 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15706 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15707 certain way.
15708
15709 Examples :
15710 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15711 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15712
15713 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15714 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15717 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015718 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15719 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15721 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015722 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15724 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015725
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015726fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15727 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15728 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15729 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15732 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15733 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15734 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15735 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15736 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15737 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15738 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15739 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015740
15741 Example :
15742 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15743 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15744 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15745 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15746 frontend mail
15747 bind :25
15748 mode tcp
15749 maxconn 100
15750 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15751 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15752 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15753 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015754
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015755hostname : string
15756 Returns the system hostname.
15757
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015758int(<integer>) : signed integer
15759 Returns a signed integer.
15760
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015761ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15762 Returns an ipv4.
15763
15764ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15765 Returns an ipv6.
15766
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015767lat_ns_avg : integer
15768 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15769 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15770 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15771 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15772 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15773 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15774 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15775 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15776 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15777 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15778 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15779 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15780 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15781 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15782
15783lat_ns_tot : integer
15784 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15785 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15786 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15787 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15788 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15789 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15790 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15791 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15792 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15793 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15794 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15795 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15796 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15797 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15798 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15799 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15800 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15801 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15802 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15803
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015804meth(<method>) : method
15805 Returns a method.
15806
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015807nbproc : integer
15808 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15809 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15810 and debugging purposes.
15811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15813 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15814 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15815 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015816 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15817 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15818 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015819
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015820prio_class : integer
15821 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15822 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15823 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15824
15825prio_offset : integer
15826 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15827 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15828 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15829 set-priority-offset".
15830
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015831proc : integer
15832 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15833 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15834 debugging purposes.
15835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015837 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15838 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15839 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15841 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15842 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15843 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15844 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15845
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015846rand([<range>]) : integer
15847 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15848 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15849 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15850 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15851 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15852
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015853uuid([<version>]) : string
15854 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15855 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15856 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15859 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15860 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15861 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15862 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15863 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015864 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15865 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15866
15867srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15869 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15870 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15871 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15872 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15873 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15874 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15875
15876 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15877 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878
15879srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15880 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15881 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15882 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015883 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15885 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15886 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15887
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015888srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15889 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15890 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15891 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15892 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15893 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15894 fetch methods.
15895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15897 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15898 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015899 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15901 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015902 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903 overloading servers).
15904
15905 Example :
15906 # Redirect to a separate back
15907 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15908 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15909 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15910
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015911stopping : boolean
15912 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15913 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15914 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15915
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015916str(<string>) : string
15917 Returns a string.
15918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15920 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15921 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15922
15923table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15924 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15925 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15926 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15927
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015928thread : integer
15929 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15930 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15931 and debugging purposes.
15932
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015933var(<var-name>) : undefined
15934 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015935 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15936 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015937 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015938 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15939 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015940 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015941 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15942 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015943 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015944 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159467.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947----------------------------------
15948
15949The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15950closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15951methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15952sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15953TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015954the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15955counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015956"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15957used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15958can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15959Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15960table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15961tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15962currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015964bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015965 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15966 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15967 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969be_id : integer
15970 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015971 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15972 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015974be_name : string
15975 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020015976 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
15977 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979dst : ip
15980 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15981 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15982 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15983 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015984 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15985 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15986 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15987 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15988 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15989 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990
15991dst_conn : integer
15992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15993 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15994 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15995 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15996 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15997 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15998 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15999 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016000
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016001dst_is_local : boolean
16002 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16003 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16004 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16005 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016006 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016007 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16008 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16009 it only once per connection.
16010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011dst_port : integer
16012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16013 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16014 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16015 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16016 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16017 an HTTP header.
16018
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016019fc_http_major : integer
16020 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16021 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16022 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16023
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016024fc_pp_authority : string
16025 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16026 if any.
16027
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016028fc_pp_unique_id : string
16029 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16030 if any.
16031
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016032fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16033 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16034 header.
16035
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016036fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16037 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16038 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16039 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16040 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16041 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16042 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16043
16044fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16045 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16046 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16047 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16048 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16049 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16050 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16051
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016052fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016053 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16054 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16055 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16056 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16057
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016058fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016059 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16060 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16061 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16062 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16063
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016064fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016065 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16066 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16067 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16068 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16069
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016070fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016071 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16072 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16073 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16074 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16075
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016076fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016077 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16078 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16079 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16080 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16081
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016082fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016083 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16084 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16085 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16086 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16087
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016088fe_defbe : string
16089 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16090 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016092fe_id : integer
16093 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016094 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16096
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016097fe_name : string
16098 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16099 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16100 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16101
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016102sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016103sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16104sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16105sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016106 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16107 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16108 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016110sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016111sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16112sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16113sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016114 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16115 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16116 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16117
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016118sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016119sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16120sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16121sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016122 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16123 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016124 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16125 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16126 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016127
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016128 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016129 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16130 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016131 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16132 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16133 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016134 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16135 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16136
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016137sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16138sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16139sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16140sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16141 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16142 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16143 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16144 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16145 when a first ACL was verified.
16146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016147sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016148sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16149sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16150sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016151 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016152 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16153
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016154sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016155sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16156sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16157sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016158 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16159 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16160 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16161
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016162sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016163sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16164sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16165sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016166 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16167 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16168 See also src_conn_rate.
16169
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016170sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016171sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16172sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16173sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016174 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016175 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016176
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016177sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16178sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16179sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16180sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16181 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16182 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16183
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016184sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16185sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16186sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16187sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16188 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16189 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016191sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016192sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16193sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16194sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016195 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16196 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16197 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016198 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16199 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16200 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016201
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016202sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16203sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16204sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16205sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16206 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16207 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16208 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16209 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16210 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16211 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16212
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016213sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016214sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16215sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16216sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016217 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016218 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16219 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16220
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016221sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016222sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16223sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16224sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016225 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16226 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16227 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16228 src_http_err_rate.
16229
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016230sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016231sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16232sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16233sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016234 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016235 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16236 src_http_req_cnt.
16237
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016238sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016239sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16240sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16241sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016242 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16243 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16244 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16245 src_http_req_rate.
16246
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016247sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016248sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16249sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16250sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016251 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016252 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16253 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16254 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16255 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016256
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016257 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016258 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16259 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016260 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16261
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016262sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16263sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16264sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16265sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16266 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16267 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16268 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16269 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16270 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016272sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016273sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16274sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16275sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016276 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16277 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16278 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016280sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016281sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16282sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16283sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016284 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16285 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16286 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016287
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016288sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016289sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16290sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16291sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016292 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016293 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16294 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16295 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016296 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016297 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16298
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016299sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016300sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16301sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16302sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016303 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16304 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16305 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16306 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16307 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016308 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016310sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016311sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16312sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16313sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016314 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16315 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16316 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16317
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016318sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016319sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16320sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16321sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016322 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16323 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016324 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016325 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16326 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16328 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16329 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331so_id : integer
16332 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16333 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16334 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016335
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016336so_name : string
16337 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16338 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16339 strings instead of integers.
16340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016342 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016343 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16344 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16345 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016346 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16347 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16348 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016349 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16350 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16351 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16352 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16353 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16354 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16355 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016356
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016357 Example:
16358 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16359 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16362 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16363 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16364 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016365 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016367src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16368 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16369 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016370 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016371 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16374 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16375 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16376 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16377 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16378 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16379 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016380
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016381 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016382 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16383 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16384 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16385 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016386 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016387 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16388 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16389
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016390src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16391 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16392 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16393 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16394 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16395 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16396 was verified.
16397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016399 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016401 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016402 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016404src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016405 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16407 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016408 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016410src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16411 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16412 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16413 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016414 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016416src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016417 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016418 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016419 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016420 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016421
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016422src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16423 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16424 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16425 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16426 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16427
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016428src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16429 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16430 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16431 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16432 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016434src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016435 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016437 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16438 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016439 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16440 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16441 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016442
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016443src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16444 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16445 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16446 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16447 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16448 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16449 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16450 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016452src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016453 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016455 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016456 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016459src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16460 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16461 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16462 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16463 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016464 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016467 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16469 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016470 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16473 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16474 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16475 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016476 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016477 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16480 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16481 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16482 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016483 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016484 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16485 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016486
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016487 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016488 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016489 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016490 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016491
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016492src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16493 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16494 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16495 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16496 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16497 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16498 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16499
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016500src_is_local : boolean
16501 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16502 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16503 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16504 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016505 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016506 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16507 once per connection.
16508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016509src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016510 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16511 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16512 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16513 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16514 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016517 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16518 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16519 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16520 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16521 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523src_port : integer
16524 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16525 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16526 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16527 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016530 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016531 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16532 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16533 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016534 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16537 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16538 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16539 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16540 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016541 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16544 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16545 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16546 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16547 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16548 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16549 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16550 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16551 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016552
16553 Example :
16554 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16555 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16556 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16557 listen ssh
16558 bind :22
16559 mode tcp
16560 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016561 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016563 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016565srv_id : integer
16566 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16567 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016568 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016569
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016570srv_name : string
16571 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16572 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016573 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016576----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16579closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16580when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16581usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016582future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016583
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001658451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16585 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16586 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16587 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16588 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16589 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16590
16591 Example :
16592 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16593 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16594 # the request.
16595 frontend http-in
16596 bind *:8081
16597 default_backend servers
16598 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16599 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16600
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016601ssl_bc : boolean
16602 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16603 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016604 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16605 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016606
16607ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16608 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016609 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16610 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016611
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016612ssl_bc_alpn : string
16613 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16614 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016615 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016616 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16617 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16618 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16619 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16620 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016621 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16622 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016623
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016624ssl_bc_cipher : string
16625 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016626 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16627 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016628
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016629ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16630 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16631 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16632 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016633 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016634
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016635ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16636 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16637 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016638 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16639 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016640
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016641ssl_bc_npn : string
16642 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16643 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016644 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016645 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16646 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16647 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16648 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016649 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16650 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016651
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016652ssl_bc_protocol : string
16653 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016654 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16655 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016656
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016657ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016658 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016659 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016660 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16661 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016662
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016663ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16664 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16665 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16666 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016667 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016668
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016669ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16670 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16671 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016672 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16673 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016674
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016675ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16676 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16677 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16678 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016679 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016680
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016681ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16682 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016683 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16684 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16687 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16688 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16689 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16690 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16691 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016693ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16694 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16695 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16696 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16697 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016698
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016699ssl_c_der : binary
16700 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16701 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16702 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016704ssl_c_err : integer
16705 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16706 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16707 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16708 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16709 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016710
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016711ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16713 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16714 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16715 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16716 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16717 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16718 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16719 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016720 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16721 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16722 LDAP v3.
16723 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16724 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726ssl_c_key_alg : string
16727 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16728 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16729 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016731ssl_c_notafter : string
16732 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16733 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16734 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016736ssl_c_notbefore : string
16737 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16738 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16739 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016740
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016741ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016742 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16743 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16744 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16745 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16746 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16747 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16748 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16749 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016750 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16751 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16752 LDAP v3.
16753 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16754 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756ssl_c_serial : binary
16757 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16758 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16759 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016761ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16762 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16763 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16764 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016765 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16766 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16767
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016768 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016769 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16772 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16773 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16774 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776ssl_c_used : boolean
16777 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16778 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780ssl_c_verify : integer
16781 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16782 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16783 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16784 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786ssl_c_version : integer
16787 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16788 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016789
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016790ssl_f_der : binary
16791 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16792 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16793 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16794
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016795ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016796 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16797 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16798 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16799 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016800 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16802 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16803 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016804 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16805 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16806 LDAP v3.
16807 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16808 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810ssl_f_key_alg : string
16811 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16812 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16813 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815ssl_f_notafter : string
16816 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16817 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16818 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820ssl_f_notbefore : string
16821 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16822 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16823 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016824
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016825ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16827 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16828 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16829 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16830 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16831 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16832 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16833 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016834 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16835 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16836 LDAP v3.
16837 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16838 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840ssl_f_serial : binary
16841 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16842 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16843 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016844
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016845ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16846 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16847 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16848 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16851 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16852 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16853 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855ssl_f_version : integer
16856 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16857 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16858
16859ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016860 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16861 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16862 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 Example :
16865 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16866 listen http-https
16867 bind :80
16868 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16869 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16870
16871ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16872 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16873 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16874
16875ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016876 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16878 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16879 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16880 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16881 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16882 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16883 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16884 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016886ssl_fc_cipher : string
16887 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16888 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016889
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016890ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16891 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16892 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016893 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016894
16895ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16896 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16897 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016898 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016899
16900ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16901 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16902 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16903 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016904 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016905 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016906
16907ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16908 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16909 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016910 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016911
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016912ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16913 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16914 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16915 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016918 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16919 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016920 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16921 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16922 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16923 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016924
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016925ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16926 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16927 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16928 wait until the handshake happened.
16929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16931 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016932 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16933 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016934 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016935 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016936
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016937ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016938 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016939 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16940 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016942ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016943 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16945 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16946 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16947 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16948 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16949 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16950 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016952ssl_fc_protocol : string
16953 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16954 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016955
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016956ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016957 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016958 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16959 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016960
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016961ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16962 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16963 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16964 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016966ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16967 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16968 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16969 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16970 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016971
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016972ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16973 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16974 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16975 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16976 BoringSSL.
16977
16978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979ssl_fc_sni : string
16980 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16981 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16982 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16983 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16984 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16985
16986 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16987 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16988 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016989 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016990 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016992 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016993 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16994 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016996ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16997 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16998 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016999
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017000
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170017.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017002------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017004Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17005sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17006only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17007For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17008be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17009can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17010sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17011for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17012content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017014payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017015 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017016 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17017 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017019payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17020 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017021 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017022 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017023
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017024req.hdrs : string
17025 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17026 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17027 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17028 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17029
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017030req.hdrs_bin : binary
17031 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17032 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17033 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17034 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17035 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17036 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17037
17038 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17039
17040 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17041 str: <int:length><bytes>
17042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017043req.len : integer
17044req_len : integer (deprecated)
17045 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17046 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17047 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17048 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17049 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17050 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17051 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17052 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017054req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17055 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017056 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17057 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17058 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17059 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017061 ACL alternatives :
17062 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017064req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17065 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17066 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17067 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17068 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017070 ACL alternatives :
17071 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075req.proto_http : boolean
17076req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17077 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17078 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17079 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17080 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17081 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17082 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17083 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085 Example:
17086 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17087 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17088 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017089 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017091req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17092rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17093 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17094 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17095 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17096 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17097 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17098 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17099 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017101 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17102 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17103 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17104 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17105 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17106 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108 ACL derivatives :
17109 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017111 Example :
17112 listen tse-farm
17113 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17114 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17115 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17116 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17117 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17118 persist rdp-cookie
17119 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17120 # This is only useful makes sense if
17121 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17122 stick-table type string size 204800
17123 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17124 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17125 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017127 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17128 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17131rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17132 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17133 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17134 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17135 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 ACL derivatives :
17138 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017139
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017140req.ssl_alpn : string
17141 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17142 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17143 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17144 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17145 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17146 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017147 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017148
17149 Examples :
17150 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17151 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17152 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017153 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017154 default_backend bk_default
17155
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017156req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17157 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17158 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017159 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17160 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17161 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17162 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17163 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17166req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17167 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17168 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17169 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17170 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17171 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17172 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17173 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175req.ssl_sni : string
17176req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17177 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17178 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17179 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17180 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17181 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17182 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17183 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17184 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17185 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17186 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17187 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17188 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190 ACL derivatives :
17191 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193 Examples :
17194 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17195 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17196 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17197 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17198 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017199
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017200req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17201 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17202 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17203 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17204 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17205 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17206 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17207 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17208 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17209 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211req.ssl_ver : integer
17212req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17213 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17214 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17215 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17216 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17217 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17218 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17219 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017220 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017221 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223 ACL derivatives :
17224 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017225
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017226res.len : integer
17227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17228 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17229 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17230 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17231 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17232 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17233 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017234 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017236res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17237 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017238 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017239 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017240 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017241 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017243res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17244 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17245 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17246 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017247 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17248 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017250 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017251
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017252res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17253rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17254 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17255 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17256 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17257 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17258 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17259 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17260 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017262wait_end : boolean
17263 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17264 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017265 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017266 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17267 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017268 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017269 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17270 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272 Examples :
17273 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17274 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17275 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17278 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17279 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17280 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17281 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17282 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17283 tcp-request content reject
17284
17285
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172867.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287--------------------------------------
17288
17289It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17290This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17291data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17292its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17293HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17294content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17295to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17296more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17297response are indexed.
17298
17299base : string
17300 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17301 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17302 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17303 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17304 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17305 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17306 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17307 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17308
17309 ACL derivatives :
17310 base : exact string match
17311 base_beg : prefix match
17312 base_dir : subdir match
17313 base_dom : domain match
17314 base_end : suffix match
17315 base_len : length match
17316 base_reg : regex match
17317 base_sub : substring match
17318
17319base32 : integer
17320 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17321 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17322 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017323 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17324 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17325 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326
17327base32+src : binary
17328 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17329 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17330 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17331 per-URL counters.
17332
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017333capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17334 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17335 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17336 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17337
17338capture.req.method : string
17339 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17340 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17341 because it's allocated.
17342
17343capture.req.uri : string
17344 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17345 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17346 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17347 allocated.
17348
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017349capture.req.ver : string
17350 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17351 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17352 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17353
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017354capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17355 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17356 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17357 The first entry is an index of 0.
17358 See also: "capture response header"
17359
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017360capture.res.ver : string
17361 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17362 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17363 persistent flag.
17364
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017365req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017366 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17367 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17368 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017369
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017370req.body_param([<name>) : string
17371 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17372 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17373 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17374 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17375 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17376 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17377 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17378 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17379 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17380 given.
17381
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017382req.body_len : integer
17383 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17384 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017385 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17386 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017387
17388req.body_size : integer
17389 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017390 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17391 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393req.cook([<name>]) : string
17394cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17395 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17396 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17397 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17398 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17399 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17400 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17401 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17402 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17403
17404 ACL derivatives :
17405 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17406 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17407 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17408 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17409 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17410 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17411 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17412 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17415cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17416 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17417 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017419req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17420cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17421 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17422 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17423 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17424 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17427 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17428 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17429 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17430 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017431 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017432 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17433 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17434 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17435 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17438 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17439 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17440 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17441 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017442 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17445 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17446 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17447 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17448 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17449 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17450 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17451 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17452 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017454req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17455 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17456 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17457 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17458 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017460req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17461 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17462 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17463 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17464 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17465 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17466 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17467 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17468 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017469 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017471 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473 ACL derivatives :
17474 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17475 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17476 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17477 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17478 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17479 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17480 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17481 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17482
17483req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17484hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17485 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17486 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17487 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17488 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17489 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17490 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17491 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17492 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17493 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17494
17495req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17496hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17497 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17498 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17499 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17500 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17501 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017502 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017503 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17504 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17505
17506req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17507hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17508 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17509 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17510 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17511 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17512 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17513 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17514 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17515
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017516
17517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017518http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17519 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17520 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17521 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17522 basic auth is supported.
17523
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017524http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17525 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17526 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17527 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17528 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17530 basic auth is supported.
17531
17532 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017533 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17534 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17535 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17536 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017538http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017539 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17540 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17541 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017542
17543http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017544 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17545 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17546 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017547
17548http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017549 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17550 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17551 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017554 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17555 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17557 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017559method : integer + string
17560 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17561 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17562 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17563 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17564 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17565 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17566 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568 ACL derivatives :
17569 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571 Example :
17572 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17573 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17574 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576path : string
17577 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17578 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17579 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17580 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17581 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017582 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017585 ACL derivatives :
17586 path : exact string match
17587 path_beg : prefix match
17588 path_dir : subdir match
17589 path_dom : domain match
17590 path_end : suffix match
17591 path_len : length match
17592 path_reg : regex match
17593 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017594
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017595query : string
17596 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17597 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17598 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17599 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017600 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017601 which stops before the question mark.
17602
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017603req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17604 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17605 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17606 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17607 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609req.ver : string
17610req_ver : string (deprecated)
17611 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17612 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17613 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 ACL derivatives :
17616 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017617
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017618res.body : binary
17619 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17620 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17621 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17622 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17623
17624res.body_len : integer
17625 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17626 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17627 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17628 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17629
17630res.body_size : integer
17631 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17632 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17633 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17634 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17635 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17636 based expect rules.
17637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638res.comp : boolean
17639 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17640 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17641 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643res.comp_algo : string
17644 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17645 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17646 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648res.cook([<name>]) : string
17649scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17650 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17651 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017652 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17653 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655 ACL derivatives :
17656 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017658res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17659scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17660 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17661 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017662 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17663 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017665res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17666scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17667 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17668 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017669 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17670 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17673 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17674 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17675 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17676 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17677 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17678 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17679 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17680 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017681 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17684 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17685 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17686 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17687 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017688 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17689 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017691res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17692shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17693 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17694 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17695 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17696 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17697 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17698 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17699 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017700 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17701 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017703 ACL derivatives :
17704 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17705 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17706 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17707 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17708 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17709 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17710 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17711 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17712
17713res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17714shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17715 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17716 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17717 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17718 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017719 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17722shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17723 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17724 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17725 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17726 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17727 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017728 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17729 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017730
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017731res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17732 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17733 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17734 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017735 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17736 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017738res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17739shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17740 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17741 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17742 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17743 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17744 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017745 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17746 based expect rules.
17747
17748res.hdrs : string
17749 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17750 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17751 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17752 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17753 based expect rules.
17754
17755res.hdrs_bin : binary
17756 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17757 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17758 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17759 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17760 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17761 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17762 (length of 0 for both).
17763
17764 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17765
17766 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17767 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017769res.ver : string
17770resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17771 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017772 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17773 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017775 ACL derivatives :
17776 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017778set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17779 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17780 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017781 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17785 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787status : integer
17788 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17789 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017790 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17791 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017792
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017793unique-id : string
17794 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17795 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17796 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17797 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17798 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17799 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017801url : string
17802 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17803 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17804 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17805 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17806 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17807 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17808 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810 ACL derivatives :
17811 url : exact string match
17812 url_beg : prefix match
17813 url_dir : subdir match
17814 url_dom : domain match
17815 url_end : suffix match
17816 url_len : length match
17817 url_reg : regex match
17818 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017820url_ip : ip
17821 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17822 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17823 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17824 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17825 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17826 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17827 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829url_port : integer
17830 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17831 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17832 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17833 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017834
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017835urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17836url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017837 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17838 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017839 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17840 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17841 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17842 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017843 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17844 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017845 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17846 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848 ACL derivatives :
17849 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17850 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17851 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17852 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17853 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17854 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17855 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17856 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017857
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859 Example :
17860 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17861 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17862 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17863 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017864
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017865urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017866 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17867 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17868 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017869
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017870url32 : integer
17871 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17872 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17873 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17874 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17875 is an unsigned integer.
17876
17877url32+src : binary
17878 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17879 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17880 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17881
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017882
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200178837.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017884---------------------------------------
17885
17886This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17887used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17888purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17889There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17890or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17891any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17892for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17893
17894internal.htx.data : integer
17895 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17896 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17897
17898internal.htx.free : integer
17899 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17900 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17901
17902internal.htx.free_data : integer
17903 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17904 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17905
17906internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17907 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17908 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17909 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17910
17911internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17912 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17913 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17914
17915internal.htx.size : integer
17916 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17917 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17918
17919internal.htx.used : integer
17920 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17921 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17922 direction.
17923
17924internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17925 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17926 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17927 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17928 of the special value :
17929 * head : The oldest inserted block
17930 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017931 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017932
17933internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17934 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17935 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17936 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17937 integer or one of the special value :
17938 * head : The oldest inserted block
17939 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017940 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017941
17942internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17943 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17944 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17945 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17946 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17947
17948 * head : The oldest inserted block
17949 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017950 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017951
17952internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17953 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17954 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17955 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17956 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17957
17958 * head : The oldest inserted block
17959 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017960 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017961
17962internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17963 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17964 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17965 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17966 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17967
17968 * head : The oldest inserted block
17969 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017970 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017971
17972internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17973 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17974 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17975 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17976 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17977
17978 * head : The oldest inserted block
17979 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017980 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017981
17982internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17983 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17984 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17985 it returns false.
17986
17987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200179887.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017989---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017991Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17992every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017993order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017995ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17996---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017997FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017998HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017999HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18000HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018001HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18002HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18003HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18004HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18005LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018006METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018007METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018008METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18009METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18010METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18011METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018012METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018013METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018014RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018015REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018016TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018017WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18018---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018019
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180218. Logging
18022----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018023
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018024One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18025provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18026very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18027provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18028state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018029to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018030headers.
18031
18032In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18033about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18034send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18035
18036 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18037 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18038 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18039 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18040 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018041 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018042 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018043
18044The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18045allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18046as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18047while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18048real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18049delay.
18050
18051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180528.1. Log levels
18053---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018054
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018055TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018056source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018057HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18058in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18059track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18060syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18061about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018062
18063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180648.2. Log formats
18065----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018066
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018067HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018068and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18069slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18070options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018071
18072 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18073 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18074 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18075 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18076 extents.
18077
18078 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18079 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18080 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18081 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18082 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18083
18084 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18085 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18086 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18087 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18088 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18089
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018090 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18091 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18092 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18093 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18094
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018095 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018097Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18098specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18099field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18100servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18101always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18102identifier.
18103
18104Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18105 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18106 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18107 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18108 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18109
18110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181118.2.1. Default log format
18112-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018113
18114This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18115as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18116format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18117
18118 Example :
18119 listen www
18120 mode http
18121 log global
18122 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18123
18124 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18125 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18126 (www/HTTP)
18127
18128 Field Format Extract from the example above
18129 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18130 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18131 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18132 4 'to' to
18133 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18134 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18135
18136Detailed fields description :
18137 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18138 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18139 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18140 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18141 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18142 and processed the connection.
18143 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18144
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018145In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18146"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18147connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18148
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018149It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18150will eventually disappear.
18151
18152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181538.2.2. TCP log format
18154---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018155
18156The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18157is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18158information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18159counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18160emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18161environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18162the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18163sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018164specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18165not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18166fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18167marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018168
18169 Example :
18170 frontend fnt
18171 mode tcp
18172 option tcplog
18173 log global
18174 default_backend bck
18175
18176 backend bck
18177 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18178
18179 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18180 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18181 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18182
18183 Field Format Extract from the example above
18184 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18185 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18186 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18187 4 frontend_name fnt
18188 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18189 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18190 7 bytes_read* 212
18191 8 termination_state --
18192 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18193 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18194
18195Detailed fields description :
18196 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018197 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18198 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18199 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018200 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018202 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018203
18204 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018205 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18206 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18207 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018208
18209 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18210 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18211 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018212 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18213 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18214 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18215 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018216
18217 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18218 and processed the connection.
18219
18220 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18221 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18222 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18223 applications.
18224
18225 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18226 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18227 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18228 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18229 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18230
18231 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18232 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18233 See "Timers" below for more details.
18234
18235 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18236 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18237 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18238 "Timers" below for more details.
18239
18240 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018241 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018242 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18243 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18244 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18245 details.
18246
18247 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18248 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18249 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18250 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18251 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18252
18253 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18254 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18255 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18256 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18257 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18258 for more details.
18259
18260 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018261 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018262 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18263 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18264 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018265 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018266
18267 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18268 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18269 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18270 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18271 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18272 caused by a denial of service attack.
18273
18274 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18275 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18276 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18277 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18278 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18279 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18280 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18281 denial of service attack.
18282
18283 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18284 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18285 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18286 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18287 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18288 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18289 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18290 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18291 be processed than on other servers.
18292
18293 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18294 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18295 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18296 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18297 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18298 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18299 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18300 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18301 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18302 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18303 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18304 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18305 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18306
18307 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18308 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18309 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18310 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18311 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18312 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018313 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018314 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18315
18316 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18317 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18318 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18319 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18320 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18321 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018322 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018323 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18324 occurs.
18325
18326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183278.2.3. HTTP log format
18328----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018329
18330The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18331is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18332the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18333are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18334emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18335generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18336"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18337which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018338frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18339is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018340
18341Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18342slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18343with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18344
18345 Example :
18346 frontend http-in
18347 mode http
18348 option httplog
18349 log global
18350 default_backend bck
18351
18352 backend static
18353 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18354
18355 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18356 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18357 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018358 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018359
18360 Field Format Extract from the example above
18361 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18362 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018363 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018364 4 frontend_name http-in
18365 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018366 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018367 7 status_code 200
18368 8 bytes_read* 2750
18369 9 captured_request_cookie -
18370 10 captured_response_cookie -
18371 11 termination_state ----
18372 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18373 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18374 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18375 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18376 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018377
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018378Detailed fields description :
18379 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018380 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18381 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18382 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018383 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018384 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018385 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018386
18387 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018388 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18389 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18390 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018392 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18393 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018394
18395 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18396 and processed the connection.
18397
18398 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18399 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18400 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18401
18402 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18403 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18404 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18405 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18406 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18407 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18408
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018409 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18410 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18411 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018412 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018413 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18414 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018415 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18416 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018417
18418 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18419 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018420 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018421
18422 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18423 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018424 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18425 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018426
18427 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18428 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18429 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18430 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18431 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018432 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18433 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018434
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018435 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18436 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18437 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18438 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18439 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18440 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18441 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018442 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018443
18444 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18445 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18446 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18447
18448 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18449 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018450 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018451 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18452 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18453 overflowing.
18454
18455 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18456 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18457 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18458 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18459 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18460 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18461 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18462 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18463
18464 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18465 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18466 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18467 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18468 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18469 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18470 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18471 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18472
18473 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18474 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18475 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18476 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18477 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18478 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18479 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18480
18481 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018482 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018483 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18484 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18485 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018486 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018487 system.
18488
18489 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18490 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18491 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18492 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18493 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18494 caused by a denial of service attack.
18495
18496 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18497 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18498 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18499 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18500 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18501 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18502 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18503 denial of service attack.
18504
18505 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18506 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18507 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18508 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18509 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18510 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18511 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18512 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18513 processed than on other servers.
18514
18515 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18516 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18517 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18518 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18519 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18520 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18521 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18522 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18523 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18524 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18525 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18526 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18527 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18528
18529 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18530 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18531 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18532 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18533 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18534 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018535 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018536 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18537
18538 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18539 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18540 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18541 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18542 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18543 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018544 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018545 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18546 occurs.
18547
18548 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18549 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18550 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18551 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18552 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18553 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18554 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18555 cookies" below for more details.
18556
18557 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18558 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18559 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18560 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18561 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18562 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18563 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18564 and cookies" below for more details.
18565
18566 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18567 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18568 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18569 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18570 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18571 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18572 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18573 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18574
18575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200185768.2.4. Custom log format
18577------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018578
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018579The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018580mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018581
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018582HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018583Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18584separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18585prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18586
18587Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18588variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018589("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018590
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018591If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018592as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018593less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18594the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018596Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018597In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018598in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018599
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018600Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18601'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18602https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18603such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18604
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018605Flags are :
18606 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018607 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018608 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18609 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018610
18611 Example:
18612
18613 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18614 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18615
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018616 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18617
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018618At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18619
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018620 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18621 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018622
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018623the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018624
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018625 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18626 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18627 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018628
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018629and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18630
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018631 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18632 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018633
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018634Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18635
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018636 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018637 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018638 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18639 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18640 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018641 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18642 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18643 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018644 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018645 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18646 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018647 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018648 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18649 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018650 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018651 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018652 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018653 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018654 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018655 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018656 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018657 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18658 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18659 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18660 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18661 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018662 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018663 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018664 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018665 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018666 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018667 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18668 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018669 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18670 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18671 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018672 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018673 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18674 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018675 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018676 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18677 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18678 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018679 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018680 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018681 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18682 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18683 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18684 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018685 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018686 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018687 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018688 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018689 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018690 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018691 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18692 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18693 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018694 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018695 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18696 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018697 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018698 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18699 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018700 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018701 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018702 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018703 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018704
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018705 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018706
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018707
187088.2.5. Error log format
18709-----------------------
18710
18711When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18712protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18713By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18714"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018715will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018716logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18717
18718The format looks like this :
18719
18720 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18721 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18722 Connection error during SSL handshake
18723
18724 Field Format Extract from the example above
18725 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18726 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18727 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18728 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18729 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18730
18731These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18732failures.
18733
18734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187358.3. Advanced logging options
18736-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018737
18738Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18739just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18740options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18741for more information about their usage.
18742
18743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187448.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18745------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018746
18747It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18748haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18749commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18750monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18751ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18752
18753 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18754 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18755 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18756 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18757
18758 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18759 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18760 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018761 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018762 such as other load-balancers.
18763
18764 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18765 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18766 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18767
18768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187698.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18770----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018771
18772The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18773what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18774or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018775"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018776just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18777log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18778after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18779is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18780with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18781with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18782
18783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187848.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18785------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018786
18787Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18788for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18789"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18790retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18791raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18792a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18793file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18794you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18795"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18796
18797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18799--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018800
18801Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18802multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18803them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18804"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18805logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18806error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18807and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18808too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18809useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18810alternative.
18811
18812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188138.4. Timing events
18814------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018815
18816Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18817reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18818the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18819frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018820mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18821addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18822
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018823Timings events in HTTP mode:
18824
18825 first request 2nd request
18826 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18827 t tr t tr ...
18828 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18829 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18830 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18831 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018832 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018833 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18834
18835Timings events in TCP mode:
18836
18837 TCP session
18838 |<----------------->|
18839 t t
18840 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18841 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18842 |<------ Tt ------->|
18843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018844 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018845 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018846 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18847 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18848 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018849 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018850 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18851 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18852 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18853 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018854
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018855 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18856 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18857 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018858 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18859 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18860 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18861 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18862 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18863 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018864
18865 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18866 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18867 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18868 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18869 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18870 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18871 request typed by hand during a test.
18872
18873 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18874 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018875 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018876 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18877 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18878 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18879 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018880
18881 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18882 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18883 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18884 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18885 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18886
18887 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18888 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18889 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18890 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18891 connection never established.
18892
18893 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18894 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18895 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18896 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18897 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18898 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18899 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18900 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18901 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18902 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18903 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18904
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018905 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18906 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18907 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18908 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18909 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18910 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18911
18912 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18913
18914 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18915 "Ta" can never be negative.
18916
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018917 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18918 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018919 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18920 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018921 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018922
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018923 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018924
18925 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018926 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18927 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018928
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018929 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18930 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18931 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18932 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18933 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18934 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18935 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18936 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18937
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018938These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18939protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18940that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018941due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18942"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18943that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018944
18945Most common cases :
18946
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018947 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18948 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18949 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18950 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18951 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18952 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18953 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18954 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18955 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18956 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18957 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018958 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018959
18960 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18961 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18962 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18963 of ms on remote networks.
18964
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018965 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18966 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18967 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018969 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18970 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18971 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18972 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18973 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18974 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18975 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18976 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18977 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018978
18979Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018981 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018982 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018983 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018984
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018985 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018986 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18987 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18988
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018989 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018990 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18991 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18992 flags.
18993
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018994 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18995 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018996 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18997 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18998 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18999 the client connection was maintained open.
19000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019001 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019002 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019003 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019004 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19005
19006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190078.5. Session state at disconnection
19008-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019009
19010TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19011"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
190122-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19013each of which has a special meaning :
19014
19015 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19016 session to terminate :
19017
19018 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19019
19020 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19021 server explicitly refused it.
19022
19023 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19024 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19025 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19026 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019027 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019028
19029 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19030 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019031
19032 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19033 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19034 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19035 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19036 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19037
19038 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19039 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19040 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19041 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19042 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19043
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019044 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19045 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19046
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019047 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19048 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19049 backup connections when going up.
19050
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019051 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019053 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19054 send or receive data.
19055
19056 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19057 send or receive data.
19058
19059 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19060 with nothing left in the buffers.
19061
19062 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19063
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019064 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019065 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19066
19067 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19068 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19069 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19070 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19071 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19072
19073 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19074 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19075
19076 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19077 server (HTTP only).
19078
19079 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19080
19081 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19082 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19083 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19084
19085 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19086 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19087 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19088
19089 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19090
19091 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19092 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19093
19094 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19095 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19096 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19097
19098 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19099 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019100 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19101 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019102
19103 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19104 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19105 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19106 another server.
19107
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019108 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019109 server.
19110
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019111 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19112 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19113 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19114 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19115
19116 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19117 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19118 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19119 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19120
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019121 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19122 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19123 "use-server" rule).
19124
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019125 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19126
19127 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19128 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19129
19130 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19131
19132 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19133 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19134 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019136 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19137 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019138 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019139 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19140 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019142 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19143
19144 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19145 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19146
19147 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19148
19149 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19150
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019151The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19152was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019153helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19154starvation, attacks, etc...
19155
19156The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19157alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19158easier finding and understanding.
19159
19160 Flags Reason
19161
19162 -- Normal termination.
19163
19164 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19165 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19166 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19167 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19168
19169 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19170 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19171 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19172 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19173 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19174 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019175
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019176 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19177 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019178 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019179
19180 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19181 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19182 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19183
19184 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19185 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19186 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19187 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19188 the server takes too long to respond.
19189
19190 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19191 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19192 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19193 long a time to respond.
19194
19195 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19196 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19197 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19198 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019199 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19200 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019201
19202 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19203 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19204 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19205 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19206 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019207 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019208 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19209 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19210 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19211 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19212 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19213 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19214 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19215 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019216 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019217 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19218 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19219 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019220
19221 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19222 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019223 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19224 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19225 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19226 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019227
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019228 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19229 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019231 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019232 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19233 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019234 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019235 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19236 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19237
19238 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19239 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19240 503 or 504 here.
19241
19242 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19243 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19244 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19245 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19246 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19247
19248 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19249 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019250 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019251 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19252 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19253
19254 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19255 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19256 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19257 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19258 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19259 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19260 between haproxy and the server.
19261
19262 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19263 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19264 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19265 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19266 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19267 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19268 solution is to fix the application.
19269
19270 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19271 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19272 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19273 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19274 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19275 external attacks.
19276
19277 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19278 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019279 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019280 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19281 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19282
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019283 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19284 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19285 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019286 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019287 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019289 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19290 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19291 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19292 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019293 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19294 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19295 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19296 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19297 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019298
19299 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19300 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19301 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19302 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19303
19304 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19305 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19306 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19307 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19308
19309 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19310 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19311 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19312 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19313
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019314The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19315persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19316important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19317re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19318
19319 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19320
19321 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19322 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19323 set on a GET request.
19324
19325 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19326 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019327 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019328 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19329
19330 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19331 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19332 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19333
19334 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19335 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19336 already got a cookie.
19337
19338 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19339 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19340 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19341 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19342 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19343
19344 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19345 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19346 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19347
19348 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19349 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19350 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19351
19352 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19353 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19354
19355 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19356 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19357 then advertised in the response.
19358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193608.6. Non-printable characters
19361-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019362
19363In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19364consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19365converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19366prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19367being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19368escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19369is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19370'}' when logging headers.
19371
19372Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19373issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19374containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19375
19376Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19377the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19378performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19379
19380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193818.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19382---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019383
19384Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19385achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019386section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019387cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19388the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19389the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019390locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019391not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19392user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19393a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19394wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19395
19396 Examples :
19397 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19398 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19399
19400 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19401 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19402
19403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19405---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019406
19407Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19408proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19409the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19410server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19411
19412Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19413response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019414section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019415
19416It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019417time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19418appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019419are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19420and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19421follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19422request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19423in the logs.
19424
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019425As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19426frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19427an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19428
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019429 Example :
19430 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19431 listen proxy-out
19432 mode http
19433 option httplog
19434 option logasap
19435 log global
19436 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19437
19438 # log the name of the virtual server
19439 capture request header Host len 20
19440
19441 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19442 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19443
19444 # log the beginning of the referrer
19445 capture request header Referer len 20
19446
19447 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19448 capture response header Server len 20
19449
19450 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19451 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19452
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019453 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019454 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19455
19456 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19457 capture response header Via len 20
19458
19459 # log the URL location during a redirection
19460 capture response header Location len 20
19461
19462 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19463 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19464 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19465 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19466 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19467
19468 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19469 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19470 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19471 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019472 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019473
19474 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19475 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19476 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19477 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19478 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019479 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019480
19481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194828.9. Examples of logs
19483---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019484
19485These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19486them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19487reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19488
19489 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19490 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19491 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19492
19493 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19494 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19495
19496 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19497 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19498 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19499
19500 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19501 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19502
19503 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19504 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19505 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19506
19507 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019508 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019509 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19510 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19511
19512 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19513 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19514 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19515
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019516 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19517 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19518 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19519 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19520 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19521 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019522
19523 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019524 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019525
19526 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19527 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19528 Nothing was sent to any server.
19529
19530 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19531 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19532
19533 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19534 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019535 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019536 send a 408 return code to the client.
19537
19538 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19539 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19540
19541 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19542 5 seconds ("c----").
19543
19544 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19545 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019546 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019547
19548 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019549 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019550 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19551 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19552 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19553 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19554 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019555
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019556
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200195579. Supported filters
19558--------------------
19559
19560Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19561accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19562unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19563
19564See also : "filter"
19565
195669.1. Trace
19567----------
19568
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019569filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019570
19571 Arguments:
19572 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19573 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19574
19575 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19576 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19577 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19578 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019580 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019581 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19582 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19583 amount of the parsed data.
19584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019585 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019586
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019587This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19588callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19589information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19590filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19591
19592Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19593tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19594a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19595
19596
195979.2. HTTP compression
19598---------------------
19599
19600filter compression
19601
19602The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19603keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019604when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19605fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19606done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19607explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19608filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19609listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19610order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019611
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019612See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19613 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019614
19615
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200196169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19617--------------------------------------------
19618
19619filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19620
19621 Arguments :
19622
19623 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19624 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19625 parsed.
19626
19627 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19628 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19629 part must be placed in its own scope.
19630
19631The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19632external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019633streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019634exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19635also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19636
19637SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19638the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19639
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019640For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019641"doc/SPOE.txt".
19642
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100196439.4. Cache
19644----------
19645
19646filter cache <name>
19647
19648 Arguments :
19649
19650 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19651
19652The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19653"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019654cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019655other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19656case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19657is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19658filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019659listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19660order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019661
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019662See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19663 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19664
19665
196669.5. Fcgi-app
19667-------------
19668
19669filter fcg-app <name>
19670
19671 Arguments :
19672
19673 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19674
19675The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19676request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19677reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19678used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19679implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19680used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19681fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19682used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19683order.
19684
19685See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19686 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19687
19688
1968910. FastCGI applications
19690-------------------------
19691
19692HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19693feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19694the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19695FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19696servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19697FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19698backend.
19699
19700HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19701application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19702connection.
19703
1970410.1. Setup
19705-----------
19706
1970710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19708--------------------------
19709
19710fcgi-app <name>
19711 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19712 document root must be defined.
19713
19714acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19715 Declare or complete an access list.
19716
19717 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19718 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19719 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19720 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19721 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19722
19723docroot <path>
19724 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19725 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19726 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19727
19728index <script-name>
19729 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19730 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19731 is an optional setting.
19732
19733 Example :
19734 index index.php
19735
19736log-stderr global
19737log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19738 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19739 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19740
19741 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19742 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19743
19744pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19745 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19746 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19747 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19748
19749 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19750 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19751 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19752 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19753
19754 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19755 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19756
19757path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019758 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019759 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19760 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19761 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19762 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19763 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19764 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19765 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019766
19767 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019768 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019769 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19770 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19771 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19772 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019773
19774 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019775 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19776 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019777
19778option get-values
19779no option get-values
19780 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19781
19782 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19783 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19784
19785 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19786 application will accept.
19787
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019788 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19789 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019790
19791 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19792 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19793 option is disabled.
19794
19795 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19796 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19797 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19798 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19799 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19800 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19801
19802option keep-conn
19803no option keep-conn
19804 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19805 sending a response.
19806
19807 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19808 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19809
19810option max-reqs <reqs>
19811 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19812 accept.
19813
19814 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19815 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19816 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19817 to 1.
19818
19819option mpxs-conns
19820no option mpxs-conns
19821 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19822
19823 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19824 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19825
19826set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19827 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19828 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19829 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19830 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19831
19832 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19833 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19834 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19835
19836 Example :
19837 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19838 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19839
19840 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19841
19842
1984310.1.2. Proxy section
19844---------------------
19845
19846use-fcgi-app <name>
19847 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19848
19849 Arguments :
19850 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19851
19852 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19853 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19854 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19855 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19856 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19857
19858 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19859 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19860 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19861 application are evaluated.
19862
19863
1986410.1.3. Example
19865---------------
19866
19867 frontend front-http
19868 mode http
19869 bind *:80
19870 bind *:
19871
19872 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19873 default_backend back-static
19874
19875 backend back-static
19876 mode http
19877 server www A.B.C.D:80
19878
19879 backend back-dynamic
19880 mode http
19881 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19882 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19883
19884 fcgi-app php-fpm
19885 log-stderr global
19886 option keep-conn
19887
19888 docroot /var/www/my-app
19889 index index.php
19890 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19891
19892
1989310.2. Default parameters
19894------------------------
19895
19896A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19897the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019898script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019899applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19900
19901 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19902 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19903 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19904 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19905 | | |
19906 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19907 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19908 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19909 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19910 | | application. |
19911 | | |
19912 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19913 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19914 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19915 | | |
19916 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19917 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19918 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19919 | | the application's configuration. |
19920 | | |
19921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19922 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19923 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19924 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19925 | | |
19926 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19927 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19928 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19929 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19930 | | be defined. |
19931 | | |
19932 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19933 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19934 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19935 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19936 | | is not set too. |
19937 | | |
19938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19939 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19940 | | set. |
19941 | | |
19942 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19943 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19944 | | the request. |
19945 | | |
19946 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19947 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19948 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19949 | | |
19950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19951 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19952 | | script to process the request. |
19953 | | |
19954 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19955 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19956 | | |
19957 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19958 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19959 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19960 | | |
19961 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19962 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19963 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19964 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19965 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19966 | | |
19967 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19968 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19969 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19970 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19971 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19972 | | side. |
19973 | | |
19974 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19975 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19976 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19977 | | connected to. |
19978 | | |
19979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19980 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19981 | | |
19982 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19983 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19984 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19985 | | |
19986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19987
19988
1998910.3. Limitations
19990------------------
19991
19992The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19993way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19994during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19995establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19996application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19997or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19998message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19999these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20000and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20001
20002Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20003request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20004requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20005
20006About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20007into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20008fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20009"http-request" ones.
20010
20011Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20012FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20013processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20014must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20015here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020017/*
20018 * Local variables:
20019 * fill-column: 79
20020 * End:
20021 */